STAT3 inhibitor
09562002 ยท 2017-02-07
Assignee
Inventors
Cpc classification
C07D409/12
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/222
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/5377
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/4709
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07C311/08
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/222
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/473
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07D413/04
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D333/54
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D211/46
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/4436
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/496
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/495
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/4436
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07C235/60
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/4709
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/5377
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/4535
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K2300/00
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K2300/00
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/4535
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07C235/64
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61P35/00
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/495
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/167
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K45/06
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/473
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/167
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K9/0019
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/496
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07D295/155
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/166
HUMAN NECESSITIES
International classification
C07C235/64
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/496
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/473
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/5377
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07D211/46
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K45/06
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/167
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/222
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/166
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07C235/60
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07C311/08
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K9/00
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07D413/04
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D409/12
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D333/54
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D295/155
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61K31/4436
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/4535
HUMAN NECESSITIES
A61K31/4709
HUMAN NECESSITIES
Abstract
Provided are STAT3 inhibitors and methods of treating inflammation or a hyperproliferative disease such as, e.g., cancer. In some aspects, compounds may be used to treat breast cancer, a head/neck cancer, a lung cancer, a prostate cancer, or pancreatic cancer.
Claims
1. A compound having the following structure: ##STR00286## wherein R.sub.1 is selected from the group consisting of substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.sub.(C1-12), substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.sub.(C4-12), acyl.sub.(C1-C6), alkylamino.sub.(C1-6), alkoxyamino.sub.(C1-6), ##STR00287## wherein R.sub.1 is not CH.sub.3; wherein X.sub.1 is Oor NH; wherein n=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; wherein R is selected from the group consisting of substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.sub.(C1-6), alkylamino.sub.(C1-6), halogen, OH, amido.sub.(C1-12), alkylsulfonylamino.sub.(C1-12), ##STR00288## substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.sub.(C4-12); wherein R.sub.11 and R.sub.12 are each independently H or alkyl.sub.(C1-6); wherein R is H, OH, NH.sub.2, or halogen; wherein R is alkyl.sub.(C1-6); wherein R.sub.2 is selected from the group consisting of NO.sub.2, NH.sub.2, H, amido.sub.(C1-12), substituted amido.sub.(C1-12), alkylsulfonylamino.sub.(C1-12), dialkylsulfonylamino.sub.(C1-12), and halogen; wherein R.sub.3 and R.sub.4 are halogen; or a salt thereof.
2. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sub.2, is NO.sub.2.
3. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sub.3, and R.sub.4 are Cl.
4. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sub.1, is selected from the group consisting of: ##STR00289## OAc, and OH.
5. The compound of claim 4, wherein R.sub.1 is selected from the group consisting of: ##STR00290##
6. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sub.2 is selected from the group consisting of: NH.sub.2, ##STR00291## H, NHAc, N(Ms).sub.2, and NHMs.
7. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has a structure selected from the group consisting of: ##STR00292## ##STR00293## ##STR00294## ##STR00295## ##STR00296##
8. The compound claim 7, wherein the compound has a structure selected from the group consisting of: ##STR00297##
9. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sub.1 is ##STR00298## and wherein R is NMe.sub.2, NHMe, NHAc, ##STR00299##
10. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has the structure ##STR00300## wherein n=1, 2, 3, or 4; wherein R is NMe.sub.2, NHMe, NHAc, ##STR00301##
11. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has the structure: ##STR00302## wherein R is NMe.sub.2, NHMe, NHAc, ##STR00303##
12. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has the structure ##STR00304## wherein R is NMe.sub.2, NHMe, NHAc, ##STR00305## ##STR00306## and wherein R is H, NH.sub.2, or Cl.
13. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has the structure: ##STR00307## wherein R is NMe.sub.2, NHMe, NHAc, ##STR00308## and wherein R is -Et or -i-Pr.
14. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sub.1 is selected form the group consisting of ##STR00309##
15. The compound of claim 14, wherein the compound has the structure ##STR00310##
16. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has the structure ##STR00311##
Description
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
(1) The following drawings form part of the present specification and are included to further demonstrate certain aspects of the present invention. The invention may be better understood by reference to one or more of these drawings in combination with the detailed description of specific embodiments presented herein.
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
(18)
(19)
(20)
(21)
(22)
(23)
DESCRIPTION OF ILLUSTRATIVE EMBODIMENTS
(24) The present invention overcomes limitations in the prior art by providing synthetic low molecular-weight compounds that specifically block STAT3 activation in breast cancer cells as well as other cancers. As shown in the below examples, the STAT3 inhibitors displayed activity in 4 breast and 3 pancreatic cancer cell lines. Several of these compounds were found to be effective in suppressing cell growth and display improved drug-like properties. The STAT3 inhibitors may be used as drug candidates for preclinical and clinical trials. The compounds may be used as preventive or therapeutic agents for various cancers including but not limited to breast cancers, pancreatic cancer, brain tumors, head/neck cancer, prostate and lung cancers as well as inflammation.
(25) High levels of activated STAT3 are often correlated with poor outcome in human breast cancer patients in terms of metastatic progression. Furthermore, increased STAT3 transcriptional activity was correlated with ER-negative phenotype in breast cancer cell lines and in primary human invasive ductal breast carcinomas. Therefore, inhibition of STAT3 may be used for the prevention and treatment of both ER-positive and ER-negative breast cancer. The inventors hypothesized that the specific STAT3 inhibitors will block STAT3 activation in mammary epithelial cells, premalignant breast cells and breast cancer cells, resulting in blockade of malignant transformation of mammary epithelial cells and reduction of breast cancer development in transgenic models. As shown in the below examples, compounds were synthesized and shown to inhibit STAT3 in breast cancer and pancreatic cancer cells. A number of compounds demonstrated significant inhibition on breast cancer cell proliferation in vitro (e.g., Table 1, Table 2, and
(26) I. Chemical Group Definitions
(27) When used in the context of a chemical group: hydrogen means H; hydroxy means OH; oxo means O; carbonyl means C(O); carboxy means C(O)OH (also written as COOH or CO.sub.2H); halo means independently F, Cl, Br or I; amino means NH.sub.2; hydroxyamino means NHOH; nitro means NO.sub.2; imino means NH; cyano means CN; isocyanate means NCO; azido means N.sub.3; in a monovalent context phosphate means OP(O)(OH).sub.2 or a deprotonated form thereof; in a divalent context phosphate means OP(O)(OH)O or a deprotonated form thereof; mercapto means SH; and thio means S; sulfonyl means S(O).sub.2; and sulfinyl means S(O).
(28) In the context of chemical formulas, the symbol - means a single bond, = means a double bond, and means triple bond. The symbol ---- represents an optional bond, which if present is either single or double. The symbol
represents a single bond or a double bond. Thus, for example, the structure
(29) ##STR00066##
includes the structures
(30) ##STR00067##
As will be understood by a person of skill in the art, no one such ring atom forms part of more than one double bond. The symbol , when drawn perpendicularly across a bond indicates a point of attachment of the group. It is noted that the point of attachment is typically only identified in this manner for larger groups in order to assist the reader in rapidly and unambiguously identifying a point of attachment. The symbol
means a single bond where the group attached to the thick end of the wedge is out of the page. The symbol
means a single bond where the group attached to the thick end of the wedge is into the page. The symbol
means a single bond where the conformation (e.g., either R or S) or the geometry is undefined (e.g., either E or Z).
(31) Any undefined valency on an atom of a structure shown in this application implicitly represents a hydrogen atom bonded to the atom. When a group R is depicted as a floating group on a ring system, for example, in the formula:
(32) ##STR00068## then R may replace any hydrogen atom attached to any of the ring atoms, including a depicted, implied, or expressly defined hydrogen, so long as a stable structure is formed. When a group R is depicted as a floating group on a fused ring system, as for example in the formula:
(33) ##STR00069## then R may replace any hydrogen attached to any of the ring atoms of either of the fused rings unless specified otherwise. Replaceable hydrogens include depicted hydrogens (e.g., the hydrogen attached to the nitrogen in the formula above), implied hydrogens (e.g., a hydrogen of the formula above that is not shown but understood to be present), expressly defined hydrogens, and optional hydrogens whose presence depends on the identity of a ring atom (e.g., a hydrogen attached to group X, when X equals CH), so long as a stable structure is formed. In the example depicted, R may reside on either the 5-membered or the 6-membered ring of the fused ring system. In the formula above, the subscript letter y immediately following the group R enclosed in parentheses, represents a numeric variable. Unless specified otherwise, this variable can be 0, 1, 2, or any integer greater than 2, only limited by the maximum number of replaceable hydrogen atoms of the ring or ring system.
(34) For the groups and classes below, the following parenthetical subscripts further define the group/class as follows: (Cn) defines the exact number (n) of carbon atoms in the group/class. (Cn) defines the maximum number (n) of carbon atoms that can be in the group/class, with the minimum number as small as possible for the group in question, e.g., it is understood that the minimum number of carbon atoms in the group alkenyl.sub.(C8) or the class alkene.sub.(C8) is two. For example, alkoxy.sub.(C10) designates those alkoxy groups having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10, or any range derivable therein (e.g., 3 to 10 carbon atoms). (Cn-n) defines both the minimum (n) and maximum number (n) of carbon atoms in the group. Similarly, alkyl.sub.(C2-10) designates those alkyl groups having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms (e.g., 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10, or any range derivable therein (e.g., 3 to 10 carbon atoms)).
(35) The term saturated as used herein means the compound or group so modified has no carbon-carbon double and no carbon-carbon triple bonds, except as noted below. The term does not preclude carbon-heteroatom multiple bonds, for example a carbon oxygen double bond or a carbon nitrogen double bond. Moreover, it does not preclude a carbon-carbon double bond that may occur as part of keto-enol tautomerism or imine/enamine tautomerism.
(36) The term aliphatic when used without the substituted modifier signifies that the compound/group so modified is an acyclic or cyclic, but non-aromatic hydrocarbon compound or group. In aliphatic compounds/groups, the carbon atoms can be joined together in straight chains, branched chains, or non-aromatic rings (alicyclic). Aliphatic compounds/groups can be saturated, that is joined by single bonds (alkanes/alkyl), or unsaturated, with one or more double bonds (alkenes/alkenyl) or with one or more triple bonds (alkynes/alkynyl). Where the term aliphatic is used without the substituted modifier, then only carbon and hydrogen atoms are present. When the term is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2.
(37) The term alkyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a monovalent saturated aliphatic group with a carbon atom as the point of attachment, a linear or branched, cyclo, cyclic or acyclic structure, and no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. Thus, as used herein cycloalkyl is a subset of alkyl. The groups CH.sub.3(Me), CH.sub.2CH.sub.3(Et), CH.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.3 (n-Pr or propyl), CH(CH.sub.3).sub.2 (i-Pr, .sup.iPr or isopropyl), CH(CH.sub.2).sub.2 (cyclopropyl), CH.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.3 (n-Bu), CH(CH.sub.3)CH.sub.2CH.sub.3 (sec-butyl), CH.sub.2CH(CH.sub.3).sub.2 (isobutyl), C(CH.sub.3).sub.3 (tert-butyl, t-butyl, t-Bu or .sup.tBu), CH.sub.2C(CH.sub.3).sub.3 (neo-pentyl), cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and cyclohexylmethyl are non-limiting examples of alkyl groups. The term alkanediyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a divalent saturated aliphatic group, with one or two saturated carbon atom(s) as the point(s) of attachment, a linear or branched, cyclo, cyclic or acyclic structure, no carbon-carbon double or triple bonds, and no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. The groups, CH.sub.2-(methylene), CH.sub.2CH.sub.2, CH.sub.2C(CH.sub.3).sub.2CH.sub.2, CH.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.2, and
(38) ##STR00070##
are non-limiting examples of alkanediyl groups. The term alkylidene when used without the substituted modifier refers to the divalent group CRR in which R and R are independently hydrogen, alkyl, or R and R are taken together to represent an alkanediyl having at least two carbon atoms. Non-limiting examples of alkylidene groups include: CH.sub.2, CH(CH.sub.2CH.sub.3), and C(CH.sub.3).sub.2. When any of these terms is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. The following groups are non-limiting examples of substituted alkyl groups: CH.sub.2OH, CH.sub.2Cl, CF.sub.3, CH.sub.2CN, CH.sub.2C(O)OH, CH.sub.2C(O)OCH.sub.3, CH.sub.2C(O)NH.sub.2, CH.sub.2C(O)CH.sub.3, CH.sub.2OCH.sub.3, CH.sub.2OC(O)CH.sub.3, CH.sub.2NH.sub.2, CH.sub.2N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, and CH.sub.2CH.sub.2Cl. The term haloalkyl is a subset of substituted alkyl, in which one or more hydrogen atoms has been substituted with a halo group and no other atoms aside from carbon, hydrogen and halogen are present. The group, CH.sub.2Cl is a non-limiting example of a haloalkyl. An alkane refers to the compound HR, wherein R is alkyl. The term fluoroalkyl is a subset of substituted alkyl, in which one or more hydrogen has been substituted with a fluoro group and no other atoms aside from carbon, hydrogen and fluorine are present. The groups, CH.sub.2F, CF.sub.3, and CH.sub.2CF.sub.3 are non-limiting examples of fluoroalkyl groups. An alkane refers to the compound HR, wherein R is alkyl.
(39) The term alkenyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to an monovalent unsaturated aliphatic group with a carbon atom as the point of attachment, a linear or branched, cyclo, cyclic or acyclic structure, at least one nonaromatic carbon-carbon double bond, no carbon-carbon triple bonds, and no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. Non-limiting examples of alkenyl groups include: CHCH.sub.2 (vinyl), CHCHCH.sub.3, CHCHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, CH.sub.2CHCH.sub.2 (allyl), CH.sub.2CHCHCH.sub.3, and CHCHC.sub.6H.sub.5. The term alkenediyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a divalent unsaturated aliphatic group, with two carbon atoms as points of attachment, a linear or branched, cyclo, cyclic or acyclic structure, at least one nonaromatic carbon-carbon double bond, no carbon-carbon triple bonds, and no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. The groups, CHCH, CHC(CH.sub.3)CH.sub.2, CHCHCH.sub.2, and
(40) ##STR00071##
are non-limiting examples of alkenediyl groups. When these terms are used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. The groups, CHCHF, CHCHCl and CHCHBr, are non-limiting examples of substituted alkenyl groups. An alkene refers to the compound HR, wherein R is alkenyl.
(41) The term alkynyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to an monovalent unsaturated aliphatic group with a carbon atom as the point of attachment, a linear or branched, cyclo, cyclic or acyclic structure, at least one carbon-carbon triple bond, and no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. As used herein, the term alkynyl does not preclude the presence of one or more non-aromatic carbon-carbon double bonds. The groups, CCH, CCCH.sub.3, and CH.sub.2CCCH.sub.3, are non-limiting examples of alkynyl groups. When alkynyl is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. An alkyne refers to the compound HR, wherein R is alkynyl.
(42) The term aryl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a monovalent unsaturated aromatic group with an aromatic carbon atom as the point of attachment, said carbon atom forming part of a one or more six-membered aromatic ring structure, wherein the ring atoms are all carbon, and wherein the group consists of no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. If more than one ring is present, the rings may be fused or unfused. As used herein, the term does not preclude the presence of one or more alkyl group (carbon number limitation permitting) attached to the first aromatic ring or any additional aromatic ring present. Non-limiting examples of aryl groups include phenyl (Ph), methylphenyl, (dimethyl)phenyl, C.sub.6H.sub.4CH.sub.2CH.sub.3 (ethylphenyl), naphthyl, and the monovalent group derived from biphenyl. The term arenediyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a divalent aromatic group with two aromatic carbon atoms as points of attachment, said carbon atoms forming part of one or more six-membered aromatic ring structure(s) wherein the ring atoms are all carbon, and wherein the monovalent group consists of no atoms other than carbon and hydrogen. As used herein, the term does not preclude the presence of one or more alkyl group (carbon number limitation permitting) attached to the first aromatic ring or any additional aromatic ring present. If more than one ring is present, the rings may be fused or unfused. Non-limiting examples of arenediyl groups include:
(43) ##STR00072##
(44) When these terms are used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. An arene refers to the compound HR, wherein R is aryl.
(45) The term aralkyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to the monovalent group -alkanediyl-aryl, in which the terms alkanediyl and aryl are each used in a manner consistent with the definitions provided above. Non-limiting examples of aralkyls are: phenylmethyl (benzyl, Bn) and 2-phenyl-ethyl. When the term is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom from the alkanediyl and/or the aryl has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. Non-limiting examples of substituted aralkyls are: (3-chlorophenyl)-methyl, and 2-chloro-2-phenyl-eth-1-yl.
(46) The term heteroaryl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a monovalent aromatic group with an aromatic carbon atom or nitrogen atom as the point of attachment, said carbon atom or nitrogen atom forming part of one or more aromatic ring structures wherein at least one of the ring atoms is nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur, and wherein the heteroaryl group consists of no atoms other than carbon, hydrogen, aromatic nitrogen, aromatic oxygen and aromatic sulfur. As used herein, the term does not preclude the presence of one or more alkyl, aryl, and/or aralkyl groups (carbon number limitation permitting) attached to the aromatic ring or aromatic ring system. If more than one ring is present, the rings may be fused or unfused. Non-limiting examples of heteroaryl groups include furanyl, imidazolyl, indolyl, indazolyl (Im), isoxazolyl, methylpyridinyl, oxazolyl, phenylpyridinyl, pyridinyl, pyrrolyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, quinolyl, quinazolyl, quinoxalinyl, triazinyl, tetrazolyl, thiazolyl, thienyl, and triazolyl. The term N-heteroaryl refers to a heteroaryl group with a nitrogen atom as the point of attachment. The term heteroarenediyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to an divalent aromatic group, with two aromatic carbon atoms, two aromatic nitrogen atoms, or one aromatic carbon atom and one aromatic nitrogen atom as the two points of attachment, said atoms forming part of one or more aromatic ring structure(s) wherein at least one of the ring atoms is nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur, and wherein the divalent group consists of no atoms other than carbon, hydrogen, aromatic nitrogen, aromatic oxygen and aromatic sulfur. As used herein, the term does not preclude the presence of one or more alkyl, aryl, and/or aralkyl groups (carbon number limitation permitting) attached to the aromatic ring or aromatic ring system. If more than one ring is present, the rings may be fused or unfused. Non-limiting examples of heteroarenediyl groups include:
(47) ##STR00073##
(48) When these terms are used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2.
(49) The term heterocycloalkyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to a monovalent non-aromatic group with a carbon atom or nitrogen atom as the point of attachment, said carbon atom or nitrogen atom forming part of one or more non-aromatic ring structures wherein at least one of the ring atoms is nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur, and wherein the heterocycloalkyl group consists of no atoms other than carbon, hydrogen, nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur. As used herein, the term does not preclude the presence of one or more alkyl groups (carbon number limitation permitting) attached to the ring or ring system. As used herein, the term does not preclude the presence of one or more double bonds in the ring or ring system, provided that the resulting groups remains non-aromatic. If more than one ring is present, the rings may be fused or unfused. Non-limiting examples of heterocycloalkyl groups include aziridinyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothiofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyranyl, oxiranyl, and oxetanyl. The term N-heterocycloalkyl refers to a heterocycloalkyl group with a nitrogen atom as the point of attachment. When the term heterocycloalkyl used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2, or C(O)OC(CH.sub.3).sub.3 (tert-butyloxycarbonyl, BOC).
(50) The term acyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group C(O)R, in which R is a hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl or heteroaryl, as those terms are defined above. The groups, CHO, C(O)CH.sub.3 (acetyl, Ac), C(O)CH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)CH(CH.sub.2).sub.2, C(O)C.sub.6H.sub.5, C(O)C.sub.6H.sub.4CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.2C.sub.6H.sub.5, C(O)(imidazolyl) are non-limiting examples of acyl groups. A thioacyl is defined in an analogous manner, except that the oxygen atom of the group C(O)R has been replaced with a sulfur atom, C(S)R. When either of these terms are used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom (including a hydrogen atom directly attached the carbonyl or thiocarbonyl group, if any) has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. The groups, C(O)CH.sub.2CF.sub.3, CO.sub.2H (carboxyl), CO.sub.2CH.sub.3 (methylcarboxyl), CO.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)NH.sub.2 (carbamoyl), and CON(CH.sub.3).sub.2, are non-limiting examples of substituted acyl groups.
(51) The term carboxylate when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group C(O)OR, in which R is a hydrogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl or heteroaryl, as those terms are defined above. The groups, C(O)OH, C(O)OCH.sub.3, C(O)OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, and C(O)OC(CH.sub.3).sub.3 are non-limiting examples of carboxylate groups. When this term is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. The groups, C(O)CH.sub.2CF.sub.3, CO.sub.2H (carboxyl), CO.sub.2CH.sub.3 (methylcarboxyl), CO.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)NH.sub.2 (carbamoyl), and CON(CH.sub.3).sub.2, are non-limiting examples of substituted carboxylate groups.
(52) The term alkoxy when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group OR, in which R is an alkyl, as that term is defined above. Non-limiting examples of alkoxy groups include: OCH.sub.3 (methoxy), OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3 (ethoxy), OCH.sub.2CH.sub.2CH.sub.3, OCH(CH.sub.3).sub.2 (isopropoxy), O(CH.sub.3).sub.3 (tert-butoxy), OCH(CH.sub.2).sub.2, O-cyclopentyl, and O-cyclohexyl. The terms alkenyloxy, alkynyloxy, aryloxy, aralkoxy, heteroaryloxy, heterocycloalkoxy, and acyloxy, when used without the substituted modifier, refers to groups, defined as OR, in which R is alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, aralkyl, heteroaryl, heterocycloalkyl, and acyl, respectively. The term alkoxydiyl refers to the divalent group O-alkanediyl-, O-alkanediyl-O, or -alkanediyl-O-alkanediyl-. The term alkylthio and acylthio when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group SR, in which R is an alkyl and acyl, respectively. When any of these terms is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, S(O).sub.2CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. The term alcohol corresponds to an alkane, as defined above, wherein at least one of the hydrogen atoms has been replaced with a hydroxy group.
(53) The term alkylamino when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group NHR, in which R is an alkyl, as that term is defined above. Non-limiting examples of alkylamino groups include: NHCH.sub.3 and NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3. The term dialkylamino when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group NRR, in which R and R can be the same or different alkyl groups, or R and R can be taken together to represent an alkanediyl. Non-limiting examples of dialkylamino groups include: N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, N(CH.sub.3)(CH.sub.2CH.sub.3), and N-pyrrolidinyl. The terms alkoxyamino, alkenylamino, alkynylamino, arylamino, aralkylamino, heteroarylamino, heterocycloalkylamino and alkylsulfonylamino when used without the substituted modifier, refers to groups, defined as NHR, in which R is alkoxy, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, aralkyl, heteroaryl, heterocycloalkyl, and alkylsulfonyl, respectively. A non-limiting example of an arylamino group is NHC.sub.6H.sub.5. The term amido (acylamino), when used without the substituted modifier, refers to the group NHR, in which R is acyl, as that term is defined above. A non-limiting example of an amido group is NHC(O)CH.sub.3. The term alkylimino when used without the substituted modifier refers to the divalent group NR, in which R is an alkyl, as that term is defined above. The term alkylaminodiyl refers to the divalent group NH-alkanediyl-, NH alkanediyl-NH, or -alkanediyl-NH-alkanediyl-. When any of these terms is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2. The groups NHC(O)OCH.sub.3 and NHC(O)NHCH.sub.3 are non-limiting examples of substituted amido groups.
(54) The term alkylphosphate when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group OP(O)(OH)(OR), in which R is an alkyl, as that term is defined above. Non-limiting examples of alkylphosphate groups include: OP(O)(OH)(OMe) and OP(O)(OH)(OEt). The term dialkylphosphate when used without the substituted modifier refers to the group OP(O)(OR)(OR), in which R and R can be the same or different alkyl groups, or R and R can be taken together to represent an alkanediyl. Non-limiting examples of dialkylphosphate groups include: OP(O)(OMe).sub.2, OP(O)(OEt)(OMe) and OP(O)(OEt).sub.2. When any of these terms is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2.
(55) The terms alkylsulfonyl and alkylsulfinyl when used without the substituted modifier refers to the groups S(O).sub.2R and S(O)R, respectively, in which R is an alkyl, as that term is defined above. The terms alkenylsulfonyl, alkynylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl, aralkylsulfonyl, heteroarylsulfonyl, and heterocycloalkylsulfonyl are defined in an analogous manner. When any of these terms is used with the substituted modifier one or more hydrogen atom has been independently replaced by OH, F, Cl, Br, I, NH.sub.2, NO.sub.2, CO.sub.2H, CO.sub.2CH.sub.3, CN, SH, OCH.sub.3, OCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, C(O)CH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.3, NHCH.sub.2CH.sub.3, N(CH.sub.3).sub.2, C(O)NH.sub.2, OC(O)CH.sub.3, or S(O).sub.2NH.sub.2.
(56) As used herein, a chiral auxiliary refers to a removable chiral group that is capable of influencing the stereoselectivity of a reaction. Persons of skill in the art are familiar with such compounds, and many are commercially available.
(57) The use of the word a or an, when used in conjunction with the term comprising in the claims and/or the specification may mean one, but it is also consistent with the meaning of one or more, at least one, and one or more than one.
(58) Throughout this application, the term about is used to indicate that a value includes the inherent variation of error for the device, the method being employed to determine the value, or the variation that exists among the study subjects.
(59) The terms comprise, have and include are open-ended linking verbs. Any forms or tenses of one or more of these verbs, such as comprises, comprising, has, having, includes and including, are also open-ended. For example, any method that comprises, has or includes one or more steps is not limited to possessing only those one or more steps and also covers other unlisted steps.
(60) The term effective, as that term is used in the specification and/or claims, means adequate to accomplish a desired, expected, or intended result. Effective amount, Therapeutically effective amount or pharmaceutically effective amount when used in the context of treating a patient or subject with a compound means that amount of the compound which, when administered to a subject or patient for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect such treatment for the disease.
(61) The term hydrate when used as a modifier to a compound means that the compound has less than one (e.g., hemihydrate), one (e.g., monohydrate), or more than one (e.g., dihydrate) water molecules associated with each compound molecule, such as in solid forms of the compound.
(62) As used herein, the term IC.sub.50 refers to an inhibitory dose which is 50% of the maximum response obtained. This quantitative measure indicates how much of a particular drug or other substance (inhibitor) is needed to inhibit a given biological, biochemical or chemical process (or component of a process, i.e. an enzyme, cell, cell receptor or microorganism) by half.
(63) An isomer of a first compound is a separate compound in which each molecule contains the same constituent atoms as the first compound, but where the configuration of those atoms in three dimensions differs.
(64) As used herein, the term patient or subject refers to a living mammalian organism, such as a human, monkey, cow, sheep, goat, dog, cat, mouse, rat, guinea pig, or transgenic species thereof. In certain embodiments, the patient or subject is a primate. Non-limiting examples of human subjects are adults, juveniles, infants and fetuses.
(65) As generally used herein pharmaceutically acceptable refers to those compounds, materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues, organs, and/or bodily fluids of human beings and animals without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problems or complications commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
(66) Pharmaceutically acceptable salts means salts of compounds of the present invention which are pharmaceutically acceptable, as defined above, and which possess the desired pharmacological activity. Such salts include acid addition salts formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like; or with organic acids such as 1,2-ethanedisulfonic acid, 2-hydroxyethanesulfonic acid, 2-naphthalenesulfonic acid, 3-phenylpropionic acid, 4,4-methylenebis(3-hydroxy-2-ene-1-carboxylic acid), 4-methylbicyclo[2.2.2]oct-2-ene-1-carboxylic acid, acetic acid, aliphatic mono- and dicarboxylic acids, aliphatic sulfuric acids, aromatic sulfuric acids, benzenesulfonic acid, benzoic acid, camphorsulfonic acid, carbonic acid, cinnamic acid, citric acid, cyclopentanepropionic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, fumaric acid, glucoheptonic acid, gluconic acid, glutamic acid, glycolic acid, heptanoic acid, hexanoic acid, hydroxynaphthoic acid, lactic acid, laurylsulfuric acid, maleic acid, malic acid, malonic acid, mandelic acid, methanesulfonic acid, muconic acid, o-(4-hydroxybenzoyl)benzoic acid, oxalic acid, p-chlorobenzenesulfonic acid, phenyl-substituted alkanoic acids, propionic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, pyruvic acid, salicylic acid, stearic acid, succinic acid, tartaric acid, tertiarybutylacetic acid, trimethylacetic acid, and the like. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts also include base addition salts which may be formed when acidic protons present are capable of reacting with inorganic or organic bases. Acceptable inorganic bases include sodium hydroxide, sodium carbonate, potassium hydroxide, aluminum hydroxide and calcium hydroxide. Acceptable organic bases include ethanolamine, diethanolamine, triethanolamine, tromethamine, N-methylglucamine and the like. It should be recognized that the particular anion or cation forming a part of any salt of this invention is not critical, so long as the salt, as a whole, is pharmacologically acceptable. Additional examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts and their methods of preparation and use are presented in Handbook of Pharmaceutical Salts: Properties, and Use (P. H. Stahl & C. G. Wermuth eds., Verlag Helvetica Chimica Acta, 2002).
(67) The term pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, as used herein means a pharmaceutically-acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, solvent or encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting a chemical agent.
(68) Prevention or preventing includes: (1) inhibiting the onset of a disease in a subject or patient which may be at risk and/or predisposed to the disease but does not yet experience or display any or all of the pathology or symptomatology of the disease, and/or (2) slowing the onset of the pathology or symptomatology of a disease in a subject or patient which may be at risk and/or predisposed to the disease but does not yet experience or display any or all of the pathology or symptomatology of the disease.
(69) Prodrug means a compound that is convertible in vivo metabolically into an inhibitor according to the present invention. The prodrug itself may or may not also have activity with respect to a given target protein. For example, a compound comprising a hydroxy group may be administered as an ester that is converted by hydrolysis in vivo to the hydroxy compound. Suitable esters that may be converted in vivo into hydroxy compounds include acetates, citrates, lactates, phosphates, tartrates, malonates, oxalates, salicylates, propionates, succinates, fumarates, maleates, methylene-bis--hydroxynaphthoate, gentisates, isethionates, di-p-toluoyltartrates, methanesulfonates, ethanesulfonates, benzenesulfonates, p-toluenesulfonates, cyclohexylsulfamates, quinates, esters of amino acids, and the like. Similarly, a compound comprising an amine group may be administered as an amide that is converted by hydrolysis in vivo to the amine compound.
(70) A repeat unit is the simplest structural entity of certain materials, for example, frameworks and/or polymers, whether organic, inorganic or metal-organic. In the case of a polymer chain, repeat units are linked together successively along the chain, like the beads of a necklace. For example, in polyethylene, -[CH.sub.2CH.sub.2].sub.n-, the repeat unit is CH.sub.2CH.sub.2. The subscript n denotes the degree of polymerization, that is, the number of repeat units linked together. When the value for n is left undefined or where n is absent, it simply designates repetition of the formula within the brackets as well as the polymeric nature of the material. The concept of a repeat unit applies equally to where the connectivity between the repeat units extends three dimensionally, such as in metal organic frameworks, modified polymers, thermosetting polymers, etc.
(71) A stereoisomer or optical isomer is an isomer of a given compound in which the same atoms are bonded to the same other atoms, but where the configuration of those atoms in three dimensions differs. Enantiomers are stereoisomers of a given compound that are mirror images of each other, like left and right hands. Diastereomers are stereoisomers of a given compound that are not enantiomers. Chiral molecules contain a chiral center, also referred to as a stereocenter or stereogenic center, which is any point, though not necessarily an atom, in a molecule bearing groups such that an interchanging of any two groups leads to a stereoisomer. In organic compounds, the chiral center is typically a carbon, phosphorus or sulfur atom, though it is also possible for other atoms to be stereocenters in organic and inorganic compounds. A molecule can have multiple stereocenters, giving it many stereoisomers. In compounds whose stereoisomerism is due to tetrahedral stereogenic centers (e.g., tetrahedral carbon), the total number of hypothetically possible stereoisomers will not exceed 2n, where n is the number of tetrahedral stereocenters. Molecules with symmetry frequently have fewer than the maximum possible number of stereoisomers. A 50:50 mixture of enantiomers is referred to as a racemic mixture. Alternatively, a mixture of enantiomers can be enantiomerically enriched so that one enantiomer is present in an amount greater than 50%. Typically, enantiomers and/or diastereomers can be resolved or separated using techniques known in the art. It is contemplated that that for any stereocenter or axis of chirality for which stereochemistry has not been defined, that stereocenter or axis of chirality can be present in its R form, S form, or as a mixture of the R and S forms, including racemic and non-racemic mixtures. As used herein, the phrase substantially free from other stereoisomers means that the composition contains 15%, more preferably 10%, even more preferably 5%, or most preferably 1% of another stereoisomer(s).
(72) Substituent convertible to hydrogen in vivo means any group that is convertible to a hydrogen atom by enzymological or chemical means including, but not limited to, hydrolysis and hydrogenolysis. Examples include hydrolyzable groups, such as acyl groups, groups having an oxycarbonyl group, amino acid residues, peptide residues, o-nitrophenylsulfenyl, trimethylsilyl, tetrahydropyranyl, diphenylphosphinyl, and the like. Examples of acyl groups include formyl, acetyl, trifluoroacetyl, and the like. Examples of groups having an oxycarbonyl group include ethoxycarbonyl, tert-butoxycarbonyl (C(O)OC(CH.sub.3).sub.3), benzyloxycarbonyl, p-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, vinyloxycarbonyl, -(p-toluenesulfonyl)ethoxycarbonyl, and the like. Suitable amino acid residues include, but are not limited to, residues of Gly (glycine), Ala (alanine), Arg (arginine), Asn (asparagine), Asp (aspartic acid), Cys (cysteine), Glu (glutamic acid), His (histidine), Ile (isoleucine), Leu (leucine), Lys (lysine), Met (methionine), Phe (phenylalanine), Pro (proline), Ser (serine), Thr (threonine), Trp (tryptophan), Tyr (tyrosine), Val (valine), Nva (norvaline), Hse (homoserine), 4-Hyp (4-hydroxyproline), 5-Hyl (5-hydroxylysine), Orn (ornithine) and -Ala. Examples of suitable amino acid residues also include amino acid residues that are protected with a protecting group. Examples of suitable protecting groups include those typically employed in peptide synthesis, including acyl groups (such as formyl and acetyl), arylmethoxycarbonyl groups (such as benzyloxycarbonyl and p-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl), tert-butoxycarbonyl groups (C(O)OC(CH.sub.3).sub.3), and the like. Suitable peptide residues include peptide residues comprising two to five amino acid residues. The residues of these amino acids or peptides can be present in stereochemical configurations of the D-form, the L-form or mixtures thereof. In addition, the amino acid or peptide residue may have an asymmetric carbon atom. Examples of suitable amino acid residues having an asymmetric carbon atom include residues of Ala, Leu, Phe, Trp, Nva, Val, Met, Ser, Lys, Thr and Tyr. Peptide residues having an asymmetric carbon atom include peptide residues having one or more constituent amino acid residues having an asymmetric carbon atom. Examples of suitable amino acid protecting groups include those typically employed in peptide synthesis, including acyl groups (such as formyl and acetyl), arylmethoxycarbonyl groups (such as benzyloxycarbonyl and p-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl), tert-butoxycarbonyl groups (C(O)OC(CH.sub.3).sub.3), and the like. Other examples of substituents convertible to hydrogen in vivo include reductively eliminable hydrogenolyzable groups. Examples of suitable reductively eliminable hydrogenolyzable groups include, but are not limited to, arylsulfonyl groups (such as o-toluenesulfonyl); methyl groups substituted with phenyl or benzyloxy (such as benzyl, trityl and benzyloxymethyl); arylmethoxycarbonyl groups (such as benzyloxycarbonyl and o-methoxy-benzyloxycarbonyl); and haloethoxycarbonyl groups (such as ,,-trichloroethoxycarbonyl and -iodoethoxycarbonyl).
(73) Treatment or treating includes (1) inhibiting a disease in a subject or patient experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease (e.g., arresting further development of the pathology and/or symptomatology), (2) ameliorating a disease in a subject or patient that is experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease (e.g., reversing the pathology and/or symptomatology), and/or (3) effecting any measurable decrease in a disease in a subject or patient that is experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease.
(74) The above definitions supersede any conflicting definition in any of the reference that is incorporated by reference herein. The fact that certain terms are defined, however, should not be considered as indicative that any term that is undefined is indefinite. Rather, all terms used are believed to describe the invention in terms such that one of ordinary skill can appreciate the scope and practice the present invention.
(75) II. Compounds of the Invention
(76) The compounds provided by the present disclosure are shown, for example, above in the summary of the invention section and in the claims below. They may be made using the methods outlined in the Examples section. These methods can be further modified and optimized using the principles and techniques of organic chemistry as applied by a person skilled in the art. Such principles and techniques are taught, for example, in March's Advanced Organic Chemistry: Reactions, Mechanisms, and Structure (2007), which is incorporated by reference herein.
(77) Compounds of the invention may contain one or more asymmetrically-substituted carbon or nitrogen atoms, and may be isolated in optically active or racemic form. Thus, all chiral, diastereomeric, racemic form, epimeric form, and all geometric isomeric forms of a chemical formula are intended, unless the specific stereochemistry or isomeric form is specifically indicated. Compounds may occur as racemates and racemic mixtures, single enantiomers, diastereomeric mixtures and individual diastereomers. In some embodiments, a single diastereomer is obtained. The chiral centers of the compounds of the present invention can have the S or the R configuration.
(78) Chemical formulas used to represent compounds of the invention will typically only show one of possibly several different tautomers. For example, many types of ketone groups are known to exist in equilibrium with corresponding enol groups. Similarly, many types of imine groups exist in equilibrium with enamine groups. Regardless of which tautomer is depicted for a given compound, and regardless of which one is most prevalent, all tautomers of a given chemical formula are intended.
(79) Compounds of the invention may also have the advantage that they may be more efficacious than, be less toxic than, be longer acting than, be more potent than, produce fewer side effects than, be more easily absorbed than, and/or have a better pharmacokinetic profile (e.g., higher oral bioavailability and/or lower clearance) than, and/or have other useful pharmacological, physical, or chemical properties over, compounds known in the prior art, whether for use in the indications stated herein or otherwise.
(80) In addition, atoms making up the compounds of the present invention are intended to include all isotopic forms of such atoms. Isotopes, as used herein, include those atoms having the same atomic number but different mass numbers. By way of general example and without limitation, isotopes of hydrogen include tritium and deuterium, and isotopes of carbon include .sup.13C and .sup.14C. Similarly, it is contemplated that one or more carbon atom(s) of a compound of the present invention may be replaced by a silicon atom(s). Furthermore, it is contemplated that one or more oxygen atom(s) of a compound of the present invention may be replaced by a sulfur or selenium atom(s).
(81) Compounds of the present invention may also exist in prodrug form. Since prodrugs are known to enhance numerous desirable qualities of pharmaceuticals (e.g., solubility, bioavailability, manufacturing, etc.), the compounds employed in some methods of the invention may, if desired, be delivered in prodrug form. Thus, the invention contemplates prodrugs of compounds of the present invention as well as methods of delivering prodrugs. Prodrugs of the compounds employed in the invention may be prepared by modifying functional groups present in the compound in such a way that the modifications are cleaved, either in routine manipulation or in vivo, to the parent compound. Accordingly, prodrugs include, for example, compounds described herein in which a hydroxy, amino, or carboxy group is bonded to any group that, when the prodrug is administered to a subject, cleaves to form a hydroxy, amino, or carboxylic acid, respectively.
(82) It should be recognized that the particular anion or cation forming a part of any salt of this invention is not critical, so long as the salt, as a whole, is pharmacologically acceptable. Additional examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts and their methods of preparation and use are presented in Handbook of Pharmaceutical Salts: Properties, and Use (2002), which is incorporated herein by reference.
(83) In some embodiments, compounds may be synthesized according to one or more of the below schemes.
(84) ##STR00074## ##STR00075##
(85) ##STR00076##
III. Process Scale-Up
(86) The above methods can be further modified and optimized for preparative, pilot- or large-scale production, either batch of continuous, using the principles and techniques of process chemistry as applied by a person skilled in the art. Such principles and techniques are taught, for example, in Practical Process Research & Development (2012), which is incorporated by reference herein.
(87) IV. Treatment of Cancer or Inflammation
(88) In various aspects a STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention may be used to treat inflammation or a hyperproliferative disease such as cancer. Inflammation may result from an inflammatory disease such as, e.g., atherosclerosis, rheumatoid arthritis, pancreatitis, cancer, or trauma. The inflammatory disease may be acute or chronic.
(89) In some embodiments, a pharmaceutically effective amount of a STAT3 inhibitor may be administered to a subject to treat a hyperproliferative disease or inflammatory disease. The subject may be a mammal such as, e.g., a human, primate, mouse, rat, dog, cat, ape, or monkey. Cancer cells that may be treated with cell targeting constructs according to the embodiments include but are not limited to cells from the bladder, blood, bone, bone marrow, brain, breast, colon, esophagus, gastrointestine, gum, head, kidney, liver, lung, nasopharynx, neck, ovary, prostate, skin, stomach, testis, tongue, or uterus. In addition, the cancer may specifically be of the following histological type, though it is not limited to these: neoplasm, malignant; carcinoma; carcinoma, undifferentiated; giant and spindle cell carcinoma; small cell carcinoma; papillary carcinoma; squamous cell carcinoma; lymphoepithelial carcinoma; basal cell carcinoma; pilomatrix carcinoma; transitional cell carcinoma; papillary transitional cell carcinoma; adenocarcinoma; gastrinoma, malignant; cholangiocarcinoma; hepatocellular carcinoma; combined hepatocellular carcinoma and cholangiocarcinoma; trabecular adenocarcinoma; adenoid cystic carcinoma; adenocarcinoma in adenomatous polyp; adenocarcinoma, familial polyposis coli; solid carcinoma; carcinoid tumor, malignant; branchiolo-alveolar adenocarcinoma; papillary adenocarcinoma; chromophobe carcinoma; acidophil carcinoma; oxyphilic adenocarcinoma; basophil carcinoma; clear cell adenocarcinoma; granular cell carcinoma; follicular adenocarcinoma; papillary and follicular adenocarcinoma; nonencapsulating sclerosing carcinoma; adrenal cortical carcinoma; endometroid carcinoma; skin appendage carcinoma; apocrine adenocarcinoma; sebaceous adenocarcinoma; ceruminous adenocarcinoma; mucoepidermoid carcinoma; cystadenocarcinoma; papillary cystadenocarcinoma; papillary serous cystadenocarcinoma; mucinous cystadenocarcinoma; mucinous adenocarcinoma; signet ring cell carcinoma; infiltrating duct carcinoma; medullary carcinoma; lobular carcinoma; inflammatory carcinoma; paget's disease, mammary; acinar cell carcinoma; adenosquamous carcinoma; adenocarcinoma w/squamous metaplasia; thymoma, malignant; ovarian stromal tumor, malignant; thecoma, malignant; granulosa cell tumor, malignant; androblastoma, malignant; sertoli cell carcinoma; leydig cell tumor, malignant; lipid cell tumor, malignant; paraganglioma, malignant; extra-mammary paraganglioma, malignant; pheochromocytoma; glomangiosarcoma; malignant melanoma; amelanotic melanoma; superficial spreading melanoma; malig melanoma in giant pigmented nevus; epithelioid cell melanoma; blue nevus, malignant; sarcoma; fibrosarcoma; fibrous histiocytoma, malignant; myxosarcoma; liposarcoma; leiomyosarcoma; rhabdomyosarcoma; embryonal rhabdomyosarcoma; alveolar rhabdomyosarcoma; stromal sarcoma; mixed tumor, malignant; mullerian mixed tumor; nephroblastoma; hepatoblastoma; carcinosarcoma; mesenchymoma, malignant; brenner tumor, malignant; phyllodes tumor, malignant; synovial sarcoma; mesothelioma, malignant; dysgerminoma; embryonal carcinoma; teratoma, malignant; struma ovarii, malignant; choriocarcinoma; mesonephroma, malignant; hemangiosarcoma; hemangioendothelioma, malignant; kaposi's sarcoma; hemangiopericytoma, malignant; lymphangiosarcoma; osteosarcoma; juxtacortical osteosarcoma; chondrosarcoma; chondroblastoma, malignant; mesenchymal chondrosarcoma; giant cell tumor of bone; ewing's sarcoma; odontogenic tumor, malignant; ameloblastic odontosarcoma; ameloblastoma, malignant; ameloblastic fibrosarcoma; pinealoma, malignant; chordoma; glioma, malignant; ependymoma; astrocytoma; protoplasmic astrocytoma; fibrillary astrocytoma; astroblastoma; glioblastoma; oligodendroglioma; oligodendroblastoma; primitive neuroectodermal; cerebellar sarcoma; ganglioneuroblastoma; neuroblastoma; retinoblastoma; olfactory neurogenic tumor; meningioma, malignant; neurofibrosarcoma; neurilemmoma, malignant; granular cell tumor, malignant; malignant lymphoma; hodgkin's disease; hodgkin's; paragranuloma; malignant lymphoma, small lymphocytic; malignant lymphoma, large cell, diffuse; malignant lymphoma, follicular; mycosis fungoides; other specified non-hodgkin's lymphomas; malignant histiocytosis; multiple myeloma; mast cell sarcoma; immunoproliferative small intestinal disease; leukemia; lymphoid leukemia; plasma cell leukemia; erythroleukemia; lymphosarcoma cell leukemia; myeloid leukemia; basophilic leukemia; eosinophilic leukemia; monocytic leukemia; mast cell leukemia; megakaryoblastic leukemia; myeloid sarcoma; and hairy cell leukemia.
(90) V. Pharmaceutical Compositions
(91) Pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention comprise an effective amount of one or more compounds of the present invention, e.g., a STAT3 inhibitor, or additional agent dissolved or dispersed in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In some embodiments, a STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention may be conjugated with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as a nanoparticle or biotin. The phrases pharmaceutical or pharmacologically acceptable refers to molecular entities and compositions that do not produce an adverse, allergic or other untoward reaction when administered to an animal, such as, for example, a human, as appropriate. The preparation of an pharmaceutical composition that contains at least one compound or STAT3 inhibitor or additional active ingredient will be known to those of skill in the art in light of the present disclosure, as exemplified by Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 21.sup.st Ed. Lippincott Williams and Wilkins, 2005, incorporated herein by reference. Moreover, for animal (e.g., human) administration, it will be understood that preparations should meet sterility, pyrogenicity, general safety and purity standards as required by FDA Office of Biological Standards.
(92) As used herein, pharmaceutically acceptable carrier includes any and all solvents, dispersion media, coatings, surfactants, conjugates, antioxidants, preservatives (e.g., antibacterial agents, antifungal agents), isotonic agents, absorption delaying agents, salts, preservatives, drugs, drug stabilizers, gels, polymers, nanoparticles, binders, excipients, disintegration agents, lubricants, sweetening agents, flavoring agents, dyes, such like materials and combinations thereof, as would be known to one of ordinary skill in the art (see, for example, Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18.sup.th Ed. Mack Printing Company, 1990, pp. 1289-1329, incorporated herein by reference). Except insofar as any conventional carrier is incompatible with the active ingredient, its use in the pharmaceutical compositions is contemplated.
(93) The compound or STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention may comprise different types of carriers depending on whether it is to be administered in solid, liquid or aerosol form, and whether it need to be sterile for such routes of administration as injection. The present invention can be administered intravenously, intradermally, transdermally, intrathecally, intraarterially, intraperitoneally, intranasally, intravaginally, intrarectally, topically, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, mucosally, orally, topically, locally, inhalation (e.g., aerosol inhalation), injection, infusion, continuous infusion, localized perfusion bathing target cells directly, via a catheter, via a lavage, in cremes, in lipid compositions (e.g., liposomes), or by other method or any combination of the forgoing as would be known to one of ordinary skill in the art (see, for example, Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18.sup.th Ed. Mack Printing Company, 1990, incorporated herein by reference).
(94) The compound or STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention may be formulated into a composition in a free base, neutral or salt form. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts, include the acid addition salts, e.g., those formed with the free amino groups of a proteinaceous composition, or which are formed with inorganic acids such as for example, hydrochloric or phosphoric acids, or such organic acids as acetic, oxalic, tartaric or mandelic acid. Salts formed with the free carboxyl groups can also be derived from inorganic bases such as for example, sodium, potassium, ammonium, calcium or ferric hydroxides; or such organic bases as isopropylamine, trimethylamine, histidine or procaine. Upon formulation, solutions will be administered in a manner compatible with the dosage formulation and in such amount as is therapeutically effective. The formulations are easily administered in a variety of dosage forms such as formulated for parenteral administrations such as injectable solutions, or aerosols for delivery to the lungs, or formulated for alimentary administrations such as drug release capsules and the like.
(95) Further in accordance with the present invention, the composition of the present invention suitable for administration is provided in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier with or without an inert diluent. The carrier should be assimilable and includes liquid, semi-solid, i.e., pastes, or solid carriers. Except insofar as any conventional media, agent, diluent or carrier is detrimental to the recipient or to the therapeutic effectiveness of the composition contained therein, its use in administrable composition for use in practicing the methods of the present invention is appropriate. Examples of carriers or diluents include fats, oils, water, saline solutions, lipids, liposomes, resins, polymers, nanoparticles, binders, fillers and the like, or combinations thereof. The composition may also comprise various antioxidants to retard oxidation of one or more component. Additionally, the prevention of the action of microorganisms can be brought about by preservatives such as various antibacterial and antifungal agents, including but not limited to parabens (e.g., methylparabens, propylparabens), chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal or combinations thereof.
(96) In accordance with the present invention, the composition is combined with the carrier in any convenient and practical manner, i.e., by solution, suspension, emulsification, admixture, encapsulation, absorption and the like. Such procedures are routine for those skilled in the art.
(97) In a specific embodiment of the present invention, the composition is combined or mixed thoroughly with a semi-solid or solid carrier. The mixing can be carried out in any convenient manner such as grinding. Stabilizing agents can be also added in the mixing process in order to protect the composition from loss of therapeutic activity, i.e., denaturation in the stomach. Examples of stabilizers for use in an the composition include buffers, amino acids such as glycine and lysine, carbohydrates such as dextrose, mannose, galactose, fructose, lactose, sucrose, maltose, sorbitol, mannitol, etc.
(98) In further embodiments, the present invention may concern the use of a pharmaceutical lipid vehicle compositions that include a compound or STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention, one or more lipids, and an aqueous solvent. As used herein, the term lipid will be defined to include any of a broad range of substances that is characteristically insoluble in water and extractable with an organic solvent. This broad class of compounds are well known to those of skill in the art, and as the term lipid is used herein, it is not limited to any particular structure. Examples include compounds which contain long-chain aliphatic hydrocarbons and their derivatives. A lipid may be naturally occurring or synthetic (i.e., designed or produced by man). However, a lipid is usually a biological substance. Biological lipids are well known in the art, and include for example, neutral fats, phospholipids, phosphoglycerides, steroids, terpenes, lysolipids, glycosphingolipids, glycolipids, sulphatides, lipids with ether and ester-linked fatty acids and polymerizable lipids, and combinations thereof. Of course, compounds other than those specifically described herein that are understood by one of skill in the art as lipids are also encompassed by the compositions and methods of the present invention.
(99) One of ordinary skill in the art would be familiar with the range of techniques that can be employed for dispersing a composition in a lipid vehicle. For example, the compound or STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention may be dispersed in a solution containing a lipid, dissolved with a lipid, emulsified with a lipid, mixed with a lipid, combined with a lipid, covalently bonded to a lipid, contained as a suspension in a lipid, contained or complexed with or conjugated with a micelle or liposome, or otherwise associated with a lipid or lipid structure by any means known to those of ordinary skill in the art. The dispersion may or may not result in the formation of liposomes.
(100) The actual dosage amount of a composition of the present invention administered to an animal patient can be determined by physical and physiological factors such as body weight, severity of condition, the type of disease being treated, previous or concurrent therapeutic interventions, idiopathy of the patient and on the route of administration. Depending upon the dosage and the route of administration, the number of administrations of a preferred dosage and/or an effective amount may vary according to the response of the subject. The practitioner responsible for administration will, in any event, determine the concentration of active ingredient(s) in a composition and appropriate dose(s) for the individual subject.
(101) In certain embodiments, pharmaceutical compositions may comprise, for example, at least about 0.1% of an active compound. In other embodiments, the an active compound may comprise between about 2% to about 75% of the weight of the unit, or between about 25% to about 60%, for example, and any range derivable therein. Naturally, the amount of active compound(s) in each therapeutically useful composition may be prepared is such a way that a suitable dosage will be obtained in any given unit dose of the compound. Factors such as solubility, bioavailability, biological half-life, route of administration, product shelf life, as well as other pharmacological considerations will be contemplated by one skilled in the art of preparing such pharmaceutical formulations, and as such, a variety of dosages and treatment regimens may be desirable.
(102) In other non-limiting examples, a dose may also comprise from about 1 microgram/kg/body weight, about 5 microgram/kg/body weight, about 10 microgram/kg/body weight, about 50 microgram/kg/body weight, about 100 microgram/kg/body weight, about 200 microgram/kg/body weight, about 350 microgram/kg/body weight, about 500 microgram/kg/body weight, about 1 milligram/kg/body weight, about 5 milligram/kg/body weight, about 10 milligram/kg/body weight, about 50 milligram/kg/body weight, about 100 milligram/kg/body weight, about 200 milligram/kg/body weight, about 350 milligram/kg/body weight, about 500 milligram/kg/body weight, to about 1000 mg/kg/body weight or more per administration, and any range derivable therein. In non-limiting examples of a derivable range from the numbers listed herein, a range of about 5 mg/kg/body weight to about 100 mg/kg/body weight, about 5 microgram/kg/body weight to about 500 milligram/kg/body weight, etc., can be administered, based on the numbers described above.
(103) A. Alimentary Compositions and Formulations
(104) In preferred embodiments of the present invention, the compound or STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention is formulated to be administered via an alimentary route. Alimentary routes include all possible routes of administration in which the composition is in direct contact with the alimentary tract. Specifically, the pharmaceutical compositions disclosed herein may be administered orally, buccally, rectally, or sublingually. As such, these compositions may be formulated with an inert diluent or with an assimilable edible carrier, or they may be enclosed in hard- or soft-shell gelatin capsule, or they may be compressed into tablets, or they may be incorporated directly with the food of the diet.
(105) In certain embodiments, the active compounds may be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of ingestible tablets, buccal tables, troches, capsules, elixirs, suspensions, syrups, wafers, and the like (Mathiowitz et al., 1997; Hwang et al., 1998; U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,641,515; 5,580,579 and 5,792, 451, each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety). The tablets, troches, pills, capsules and the like may also contain the following: a binder, such as, for example, gum tragacanth, acacia, cornstarch, gelatin or combinations thereof; an excipient, such as, for example, dicalcium phosphate, mannitol, lactose, starch, magnesium stearate, sodium saccharine, cellulose, magnesium carbonate or combinations thereof; a disintegrating agent, such as, for example, corn starch, potato starch, alginic acid or combinations thereof; a lubricant, such as, for example, magnesium stearate; a sweetening agent, such as, for example, sucrose, lactose, saccharin or combinations thereof; a flavoring agent, such as, for example peppermint, oil of wintergreen, cherry flavoring, orange flavoring, etc. When the dosage unit form is a capsule, it may contain, in addition to materials of the above type, a liquid carrier. Various other materials may be present as coatings or to otherwise modify the physical form of the dosage unit. For instance, tablets, pills, or capsules may be coated with shellac, sugar, or both. When the dosage form is a capsule, it may contain, in addition to materials of the above type, carriers such as a liquid carrier. Gelatin capsules, tablets, or pills may be enterically coated. Enteric coatings prevent denaturation of the composition in the stomach or upper bowel where the pH is acidic. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,629,001. Upon reaching the small intestines, the basic pH therein dissolves the coating and permits the composition to be released and absorbed by specialized cells, e.g., epithelial enterocytes and Peyer's patch M cells. A syrup of elixir may contain the active compound sucrose as a sweetening agent methyl and propylparabens as preservatives, a dye and flavoring, such as cherry or orange flavor. Of course, any material used in preparing any dosage unit form should be pharmaceutically pure and substantially non-toxic in the amounts employed. In addition, the active compounds may be incorporated into sustained-release preparation and formulations.
(106) For oral administration the compositions of the present invention may alternatively be incorporated with one or more excipients in the form of a mouthwash, dentifrice, buccal tablet, oral spray, or sublingual orally-administered formulation. For example, a mouthwash may be prepared incorporating the active ingredient in the required amount in an appropriate solvent, such as a sodium borate solution (Dobell's Solution). Alternatively, the active ingredient may be incorporated into an oral solution such as one containing sodium borate, glycerin and potassium bicarbonate, or dispersed in a dentifrice, or added in a therapeutically-effective amount to a composition that may include water, binders, abrasives, flavoring agents, foaming agents, and humectants. Alternatively the compositions may be fashioned into a tablet or solution form that may be placed under the tongue or otherwise dissolved in the mouth.
(107) Additional formulations which are suitable for other modes of alimentary administration include suppositories. Suppositories are solid dosage forms of various weights and shapes, usually medicated, for insertion into the rectum. After insertion, suppositories soften, melt or dissolve in the cavity fluids. In general, for suppositories, traditional carriers may include, for example, polyalkylene glycols, triglycerides or combinations thereof. In certain embodiments, suppositories may be formed from mixtures containing, for example, the active ingredient in the range of about 0.5% to about 10%, and preferably about 1% to about 2%.
(108) B. Parenteral Compositions and Formulations
(109) In further embodiments, a compound or STAT3 inhibitor of the present invention may be administered via a parenteral route. As used herein, the term parenteral includes routes that bypass the alimentary tract. Specifically, the pharmaceutical compositions disclosed herein may be administered for example, but not limited to intravenously, intradermally, intramuscularly, intraarterially, intrathecally, subcutaneous, or intraperitoneally U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,613,308, 5,466,468, 5,543,158; 5,641,515; and 5,399,363 (each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
(110) Solutions of the active compounds as free base or pharmacologically acceptable salts may be prepared in water suitably mixed with a surfactant, such as hydroxypropylcellulose. Dispersions may also be prepared in glycerol, liquid polyethylene glycols, and mixtures thereof and in oils. Under ordinary conditions of storage and use, these preparations contain a preservative to prevent the growth of microorganisms. The pharmaceutical forms suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersions (U.S. Pat. No. 5,466,468, specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety). In all cases the form must be sterile and must be fluid to the extent that easy injectability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms, such as bacteria and fungi. The carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (i.e., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), suitable mixtures thereof, and/or vegetable oils. Proper fluidity may be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants. The prevention of the action of microorganisms can be brought about by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like. In many cases, it will be preferable to include isotonic agents, for example, sugars or sodium chloride. Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by the use in the compositions of agents delaying absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
(111) For parenteral administration in an aqueous solution, for example, the solution should be suitably buffered if necessary and the liquid diluent first rendered isotonic with sufficient saline or glucose. These particular aqueous solutions are especially suitable for intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous, and intraperitoneal administration. In this connection, sterile aqueous media that can be employed will be known to those of skill in the art in light of the present disclosure. For example, one dosage may be dissolved in isotonic NaCl solution and either added hypodermoclysis fluid or injected at the proposed site of infusion, (see for example, Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 15th Edition, pages 1035-1038 and 1570-1580). Some variation in dosage will necessarily occur depending on the condition of the subject being treated. The person responsible for administration will, in any event, determine the appropriate dose for the individual subject. Moreover, for human administration, preparations should meet sterility, pyrogenicity, general safety and purity standards as required by FDA Office of Biologics standards.
(112) Sterile injectable solutions are prepared by incorporating the active compounds in the required amount in the appropriate solvent with various of the other ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the various sterilized active ingredients into a sterile vehicle which contains the basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions, the preferred methods of preparation are vacuum-drying and freeze-drying techniques which yield a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof. A powdered composition is combined with a liquid carrier such as, e.g., water or a saline solution, with or without a stabilizing agent.
(113) C. Miscellaneous Pharmaceutical Compositions and Formulations
(114) In other preferred embodiments of the invention, the active compound or STAT3 inhibitor may be formulated for administration via various miscellaneous routes, for example, topical or transdermal administration, mucosal administration (intranasal, vaginal, etc.) and/or inhalation.
(115) Pharmaceutical compositions for topical administration may include the active compound formulated for a medicated application such as an ointment, paste, cream or powder. Ointments include all oleaginous, adsorption, emulsion and water-solubly based compositions for topical application, while creams and lotions are those compositions that include an emulsion base only. Topically administered medications may contain a penetration enhancer to facilitate adsorption of the active ingredients through the skin. Suitable penetration enhancers include glycerin, alcohols, alkyl methyl sulfoxides, pyrrolidones and luarocapram. Possible bases for compositions for topical application include polyethylene glycol, lanolin, cold cream and petrolatum as well as any other suitable absorption, emulsion or water-soluble ointment base. Topical preparations may also include emulsifiers, gelling agents, and antimicrobial preservatives as necessary to preserve the active ingredient and provide for a homogenous mixture. Transdermal administration of the present invention may also comprise the use of a patch. For example, the patch may supply one or more active substances at a predetermined rate and in a continuous manner over a fixed period of time.
(116) In certain embodiments, the pharmaceutical compositions may be delivered by eye drops, intranasal sprays, inhalation, and/or other aerosol delivery vehicles. Methods for delivering compositions directly to the lungs via nasal aerosol sprays has been described e.g., in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,756,353 and 5,804,212 (each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety). Likewise, the delivery of drugs using intranasal microparticle resins (Takenaga et al., 1998) and lysophosphatidyl-glycerol compounds (U.S. Pat. No. 5,725,871, specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety) are also well-known in the pharmaceutical arts. Likewise, transmucosal drug delivery in the form of a polytetrafluoroetheylene support matrix is described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,780,045 (specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
(117) The term aerosol refers to a colloidal system of finely divided solid of liquid particles dispersed in a liquefied or pressurized gas propellant. The typical aerosol of the present invention for inhalation will consist of a suspension of active ingredients in liquid propellant or a mixture of liquid propellant and a suitable solvent. Suitable propellants include hydrocarbons and hydrocarbon ethers. Suitable containers will vary according to the pressure requirements of the propellant. Administration of the aerosol will vary according to subject's age, weight and the severity and response of the symptoms.
(118) VI. Examples
(119) The following examples are included to demonstrate preferred embodiments of the invention. It should be appreciated by those of skill in the art that the techniques disclosed in the examples which follow represent techniques discovered by the inventor to function well in the practice of the invention, and thus can be considered to constitute preferred modes for its practice. However, those of skill in the art should, in light of the present disclosure, appreciate that many changes can be made in the specific embodiments which are disclosed and still obtain a like or similar result without departing from the spirit and scope of the invention.
EXAMPLE 1
Synthesis of Compounds
(120) The following experimental procedures were used to generate the following compounds.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)-2-(2-morpholin-4-yl-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-1-14)
(121) ##STR00077##
(122) To a solution of niclosamide (150 mg, 0.46 mmol) and PPh.sub.3 (217 mg, 0.83 mmol) in THF (8 mL) was added 2-morpholin-4-yl-ethanol (108 mg, 0.83 mmol) and DIAD (168 mg, 0.83 mmol). The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 1 h. The mixture was partitioned between EtOAc (50 mL) and H.sub.2O (30 mL). The organic layer was added 10% HCl (3 mL). A white suspension formed during the course of addition. The solid was filtrated and washed with EtOAc (20 mL). The solid was suspended in EtOAc (50 mL), and basified with 10% NaHCO.sub.3. The organic layer was dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, concentrated to give a yellow solid. The crude product was purified with silica gel column (DCM/MeOH=50/1) to obtain HJC-1-14 (119 mg, 59%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.63 (s, 1H), 8.75 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.31 (s, 1H), 8.20 (s, 1H), 8.19 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 7.47 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.05 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.40 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.39-3.41 (m, 4H), 2.84 (d, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.43-2.45 (m, 4H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.5, 155.2, 143.2, 141.1, 133.8, 132.4, 127.6, 124.7, 123.5, 123.4, 122.8, 122.0, 115.2, 67.5, 66.7, 56.8, 53.7.
4-[4-Chloro-2-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenylcarbamoyl)phenoxyl]piperidine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester (HJC-1-16)
(123) ##STR00078##
(124) To a solution of niclosamide (200 mg, 0.6 mmol) and PPh.sub.3 (288 mg, 1.1 mmol) in THF (10 mL) was added tert-butyl 4-hydroxypiperidine-1-carboxylate (222 mg, 1.1 mmol) and DIAD (222 mg, 1.1 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at r.t. for 4 h, and then it was partitioned between EtOAc (50 mL) and H.sub.2O (20 mL). The organic layer was washed with brine (10 mL), dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, and concentrated to give the crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (hexane/EtOAc=3/1) to afford HJC-1-16 (180 mg, 58%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.17 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.32 (s, 1H), 8.20 (d, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 8.17 (s, 1H), 7.46 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.03 (d, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 4.61-4.63 (m, 1H), 3.99-3.41 (m, 2H), 2.98-3.02 (m, 2H), 210-2.12 (m, 2H), 1.81-1.83 (m, 2H), 1.45 (s, 9H).
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)-2-(piperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-1-25)
(125) ##STR00079##
(126) To a solution of HJC-1-16 (150 mg, 0.29 mmol) in DCM (4 mL) was added TFA (1 mL) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at 0 C. for 1 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated, and the residue was partitioned between EtOAc (50 mL) and 1 N NaHCO.sub.3 (10 mL). The organic layer was washed with brine (10 mL), dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, and concentrated to give the crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (DCM/MeOH=10/1) to provide HJC-1-25 (70 mg, 58%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CD.sub.3OD) 8.71 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.24 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 7.96 (s, 1H), 7.55 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.91-4.94 (m, 1H), 3.40-3.43 (m, 2H), 3.13-3.18 (m, 2H), 2.32-2.35 (m, 2H), 2.04-2.10 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CD.sub.3OD) 164.8, 154.6, 145.1, 141.9, 134.6, 132.3, 128.3, 126.1, 125.9, 125.0, 124.3, 123.5, 117.6, 73.6, 42.9, 29.1.
2-Phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)amide (HJC-1-17)
(127) ##STR00080##
(128) To a solution of 2-phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (249 mg, 1.0 mmol) and 2-chloro-4-nitrobenzenamine (173 mg, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added Et.sub.3N (304 mg, 3.0 mmol). HBTU (606 mg, 1.6 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 28 h. A white suspension formed during the reaction. The precipitate was collected by filtration and washed with DCM (50 mL) and EtOAc (50 mL). The desired product was obtained as a white solid (150 mg, 37%). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 8.62-8.64 (m, 1H), 8.51-8.53 (m, 1H), 8.32-8.36 (m, 1H), 7.94-7.97 (m, 4H), 7.75-7.77 (m, 1H), 7.50-7.53 (m, 5H), 7.19-7.21 (m, 1H).
2-Phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-amide (HJC-1-23)
(129) ##STR00081##
(130) To a solution of 2-phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (249 mg, 1.0 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (181 mg, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added DIPEA (388 mg, 3.0 mmol). HBTU (569 mg, 1.5 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 28 h. An additional amount of HBTU (190 mg, 0.5 mmol) was added to the solution at 0 C., and the resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 24 h. A white suspension formed during the reaction. The precipitate was dissolved in DMF (10 mL). The solution was added to the stirring water dropwise. A yellow solid was formed. The solid was filtered and washed with H.sub.2O. 160 mg of the desired product was obtained as a yellow solid (39% yield). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 11.29 (s, 1H), 8.44 (s, 1H), 8.38 (d, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.20 (dd, 2H, J=5.4 Hz, 13.8 Hz), 7.98 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.88 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.54-7.70 (m, 6H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 165.8, 155.8, 147.9, 142.2, 141.2, 138.0, 137.2, 132.9, 130.5, 130.4, 130.0, 129.7, 129.0, 127.6, 127.3, 126.6, 126.3, 125.1, 124.2, 123.0, 117.1, 117.1, 112.3, 112.3.
2-Phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (1-phenyl-ethyl)amide (HJC-1-28)
(131) ##STR00082##
(132) To a solution of 2-phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (249 mg, 1.0 mmol) and L()--methylbenzylamine (127 mg, 1.05 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added DIPEA (388 mg, 3.0 mmol). HBTU (569 mg, 1.5 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 3 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with DCM (80 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give a crude product, which was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/3) to obtain HJC-1-28 (330 mg, 94%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 8.03-8.07 (m, 3H), 7.97 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.71 (s, 1H), 7.67 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.28-7.48 (m, 9H), 6.78 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 5.38-5.43 (m, 1H), 1.66 (d, 3H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 166.8, 156.7, 148.6, 142.9, 142.7, 138.8, 130.1, 130.0, 130.0, 129.8, 128.9, 127.8, 127.6, 127.3, 126.4, 125.0, 125.0, 123.4, 116.4, 116.3, 49.7, 22.0.
N-(4-Amino-2-chloro-phenyl)-5-chloro-2-hydroxy-benzamide (HJC-1-29)
(133) ##STR00083##
(134) To a solution of niclosamide (500 mg, 1.53 mmol) in 20 mL of MeOH was added 4 mL of saturated NH.sub.4Cl (a.q.). Zinc dust (994 mg, 15.3 mmol) was added into the solution at 0 C. The reaction was stirred at r.t. for 16 h. TLC indicated that the starting material was gone. 100 mL of MeOH was added to the solution. The Zinc solid was filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated under vacuum to give a yellow solid. The desired product (455 mg, 100%) was filtered as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 11.94 (s, 1H), 7.83-7.87 (m, 2H), 7.11 (s, 1H), 6.96 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 6.64 (s, 1H), 6.51 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 5.05-5.15 (bs, 2H), 3.23 (s, 1H).
5-Chloro-2-hydroxy-N-(1-phenyl-ethyl)benzamide (HJC-1-30)
(135) ##STR00084##
(136) To a solution of 5-chloro-2-hydroxy-benzoic acid (173 mg, 1.0 mmol) and L()--methylbenzylamine (122 mg, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added DIPEA (388 mg, 3.0 mmol). HBTU (569 mg, 1.5 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 16 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with DCM (80 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give a crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/10) to afford HJC-1-30 (108 mg, 39%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 12.22 (s, 1H), 7.28-7.48 (m, 7H), 6.93 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.55 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 5.29-5.34 (m, 1H), 1.64 (d, 3H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 168.2, 160.2, 142.3, 134.2, 129.0, 129.0, 127.9, 126.3, 126.3, 125.2, 123.4, 120.2, 115.4, 49.5, 21.8.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2,6-diphenyl-isonicotinamide (HJC-1-36)
(137) ##STR00085##
(138) To a solution of 2,6-diphenylisonicotinic acid (150 mg, 0.6 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (119 mg, 0.7 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added DIPEA (211 mg, 1.6 mmol). HBTU (330 mg, 0.9 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 28 h. An additional amount of HBTU (190 mg, 0.5 mmol) was added to the solution at 0 C., and the resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 24 h. The mixture was diluted with DCM (50 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give a crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/2) to provide HJC-1-36 (120 mg, 50%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.76 (s, 1H), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 8.23 (d, 4H, J=7.2 Hz), 8.14 (s, 2H) 7.93 (s, 1H), 7.41-7.55 (m, 6H), 7.40 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.13-7.15 (m, 1H), 6.26-6.28 (m, 1H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.7, 156.6, 143.9, 141.1, 138.1, 137.1, 132.8, 130.4, 129.7, 129.0, 126.9, 126.6, 126.3, 124.6, 116.7, 112.7.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-methanesulfonylamino-phenyl)-2-hydroxybenzamide (HJC-1-31)
(139) ##STR00086##
(140) To a solution of N-(4-amino-2-chlorophenyl)-5-chloro-2-hydroxybenzamide (HJC-1-29) (120 mg, 0.4 mmol) in 10 mL of acetone was added Et.sub.3N (61 mg, 0.6 mmol). MsCl (51 mg, 0.44 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 4 h. The mixture was concentrated. The residue was diluted with EtOAc (75 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give a crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (DCM/MeOH=30/1) to obtain HJC-1-31 (105 mg, 69%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.28 (s, 1H), 8.10 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.90 (s, 1H), 7.53 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.48 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 6.77 (s, 1H), 6.65 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 3.70 (s, 1H), 3.22 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 161.9, 145.3, 144.2, 133.6, 132.3, 130.7, 130.6, 126.2, 125.1, 124.9, 124.7, 115.3, 114.2, 38.2.
Acetic acid 2-(4-acetylamino-2-chloro-phenylcarbamoyl)-4-chlorophenyl ester (HJC-1-37)
(141) ##STR00087##
(142) To the mixture of N-(4-amino-2-chlorophenyl)-5-chloro-2-hydroxybenzamide (HJC-1-29) (200 mg, 0.67 mmol) in 10 mL of acetone was added Et.sub.3N (341 mg, 3.4 mmol). AcCl (159 mg, 2.0 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at 50 C. for 2 h. The mixture was concentrated and then the residue was washed with acetone (3 mL). The desired product was filtered as a pale yellow solid (250 mg, 98%). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.45 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.98 (s, 1H), 7.96 (s, 1H), 7.50 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.14-7.17 (m, 3H), 2.37 (s, 3H), 2.17 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 168.7, 168.6, 162.9, 146.9, 138.3, 131.4, 130.4, 129.9, 129.1, 129.0, 128.8, 128.2, 125.5, 119.3, 117.8, 24.0, 20.8.
N-(4-Acetylamino-2-chlorophenol)-5-chloro-2-hydroxybenzamide (HJC-1-40)
(143) ##STR00088##
(144) To a solution of acetic acid 2-(4-acetylamino-2-chloro-phenylcarbamoyl)-4-chloro-phenyl ester (HJC-1-37) (150 mg, 0.4 mmol) in 10 mL of MeOH and 2.5 mL of H.sub.2O was added LiOH (66 mg, 1.6 mmol) at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 1 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (100 mL) and washed with water (20 mL) and 2 N HCl (5 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give the desired product (130 mg, 97%) as a yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 12.23 (s, 1H), 10.75 (s, 1H), 10.14 (s, 1H), 8.21 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.99 (s, 1H), 7.96 (s, 1H), 7.50 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.43 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.06 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 2.05 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 168.5, 162.9, 156.1, 136.6, 133.3, 130.0, 129.5, 123.9, 123.5, 123.1, 119.5, 119.2, 119.2, 118.0, 24.0.
Acridine-9-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (HJC-1-41)
(145) ##STR00089##
(146) To a solution of acridine-9-carboxylic acid (150 mg, 0.67 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (146 mg, 0.81 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added DIPEA (434 mg, 3.36 mmol). HBTU (637 mg, 1.68 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 2 days. A yellow suspension formed during the reaction. The mixture was filtered. The precipitate was dissolved in DMF (10 mL). The solution was added to the stirring water dropwise. A yellow solid was formed. The solid was filtered and washed with H.sub.2O (100 mL). 100 mg of the desired product was obtained as a yellow solid (39% yield). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 8.71 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.32 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.08-8.13 (m, 5H), 7.97 (t, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.82 (t, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.68 (t, 2H, J=7.8 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.4, 147.9, 136.1, 133.9, 132.9, 131.1, 129.5, 128.0, 128.0, 125.2, 121.7, 116.5, 115.5.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-hydroxybenzamide (HJC-1-49)
(147) ##STR00090##
(148) A solution of 5-chloro-2-hydroxybenzoic acid (2.0 g, 11 mmol) and 4 mL of SOCl.sub.2 in 4 mL of toluene was stirred at 110 C. overnight. The mixture was concentrated to give a crude product as a pale yellow oil. To the solution of pyridine (869 mg, 11 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (200 mg, 1.1 mmol) was added the solution of the acid chloride (500 mg, 2.6 mmol) in DMF (15 mL) dropwise at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 4 h. The mixture was added to the water solution dropwise. The yellow solid was formed and filtrated. To the mixture of one half of the crude product in THF (8 mL) was added 1 N LiOH (0.7 mL, 0.7 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at 0 C. for 30 min. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (50 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (10 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was washed with DCM (20 mL) to give the desired product (40 mg, 22%) as a yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 11.50 (s, 1H), 10.74 (s, 1H), 8.25 (s, 1H), 7.92 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.86 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.59-7.62 (m, 2H), 7.48 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.31 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.04 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 165.1, 156.2, 140.7, 137.1, 133.1, 132.8, 130.3, 128.6, 126.5, 126.2, 124.6, 122.8, 120.4, 119.0, 112.7.
5-(5-Chloro-2-hydroxybenzoylamino)-2-vinylbenzenesulfonic acid methyl ester (HJC-1-47)
(149) ##STR00091##
(150) To the solution of HJC-1-49 (400 mg, 0.82 mmol) in MeOH (8 mL) was added 10% NaOH (2 mL, 4.9 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 15 min. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (100 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (20 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was washed with DCM (20 mL) to give the desired product (90 mg, 30%). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 11.52 (s, 1H), 10.73 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s, 1H), 7.95 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.88 (s, 1H), 7.70 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.49 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.03 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 5.17-5.18 (m, 1H), 3.96-3.99 (m, 1H), 3.65-3.67 (dd, 1H, J=3.0, 13.8 Hz), 3.40 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 165.2, 156.3, 140.5, 139.8, 133.1, 132.7, 128.6, 128.3, 125.7, 122.8, 120.2, 119.0, 111.1, 74.5, 56.8, 56.0.
5-Chloro-N-(5-furan-2-yl-[1,3,4]oxadiazol-2-yl)-2-hydroxybenzamide (HJC-1-51)
(151) ##STR00092##
(152) To the solution of pyridine (1.05 g, 13.2 mmol) and 5-furan-2-yl-[1,3,4]oxadiazol-2-ylamine (100 mg, 0.66 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) was added the solution of the acid chloride (400 mg, 2.1 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) dropwise at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 2 h. The reaction mixture was then added to the water solution dropwise. The yellow solid was formed and filtered. To the mixture of one half of the crude product in THF (20 mL) and H.sub.2O (2 mL) was added 1 N LiOH (2.7 mL, 2.7 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 30 min. Then the mixture was diluted with EtOAc (20 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (10 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was washed with DCM (10 mL) to provide the desired product (80 mg, 50%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.11 (s, 1H), 8.13 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.02 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.64 (dd, 1H, J=2.4 Hz and 8.4 Hz), 7.49 (dd, 1H, J=2.4 Hz and 8.4 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.99 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.4, 158.4, 148.3, 135.2, 133.6, 130.8, 130.6, 130.2, 126.2, 125.9, 122.6, 119.7, 115.4.
{2-[4-Chloro-2-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenylcarbamoyl)-phenoxy]-ethyl}-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (HJC-1-50)
(153) ##STR00093##
(154) To a solution of niclosamide (327 mg, 1.0 mmol) and PPh.sub.3 (341 mg, 1.3 mmol) in THF (10 mL) was added (2-hydroxyethyl)-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (193 mg, 1.2 mmol) in THF (10 mL) and DIAD (263 mg, 1.3 mmol). The mixture was stirred at r.t. overnight, and then was concentrated to give the crude product. This residue was washed with DCM (20 mL) to obtain HJC-1-50 (290 mg, 71%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.45 (s, 1H), 8.90 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.21-8.24 (m, 2H), 7.49 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.08 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.84-4.85 (m, 1H), 4.41 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 3.62 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 1.40 (s, 9H).
2-(2-Aminoethoxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-1-52)
(155) ##STR00094##
(156) To a solution of HJC-1-50 (230 mg, 0.57 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) was added TFA (2.5 mL) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 2 h, and then was concentrated. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc (250 mL) and 1 N NaHCO.sub.3 (10 mL). The organic layer was washed with H.sub.2O (10 mL) and dried with Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The organic layer was concentrated. The residue was washed with EtOAc (20 mL) to give HJC-1-52 (140 mg, 77%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.85 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.32 (s, 1H), 8.18-8.20 (m, 2H), 7.47 (dd, 1H, J=3.0 Hz and 9.0 Hz), 7.05 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.31 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.22 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 1.89-1.93 (bs, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.7, 154.5, 143.4, 141.1, 133.7, 130.9, 125.7, 124.9, 124.6, 123.6, 123.6, 122.8, 115.8, 66.4, 38.1.
2-Phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (3-methoxy-1,1-dioxo-2,3-dihydro-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (HJC-1-57)
(157) ##STR00095##
(158) To the solution of HJC-1-23 (15 mg, 0.036 mmol) in MeOH (4 mL) was added 10% NaOH (0.2 mL, 0.5 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 5 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (50 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (10 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the desired product (17 mg, 100%). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.46 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 8.23-8.29 (m, 2H), 8.11-8.18 (m, 3H), 8.08 (s, 1H), 7.79 (t, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.69 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.62 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.46-7.50 (m, 3H), 5.11-5.13 (m, 1H), 3.62-3.66 (m, 1H), 3.50 (s, 3H), 3.33-3.35 (m, 1H).
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acetamide (HJC-1-62)
(159) ##STR00096##
(160) To the solution of DIPEA (713 mg, 5.5 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (500 mg, 2.8 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added the solution of AcCl (260 mg, 3.3 mmol) in DCM (15 mL) dropwise at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 10 min. The mixture was diluted with DCM (50 mL) and washed with H.sub.2O (10 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/1) to afford the desired product (400 mg, 65%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.44 (s, 1H), 8.12 (s, 1H), 7.68 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.56 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.51 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.25 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.10 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 169.1, 141.7, 137.2, 132.9, 129.8, 126.5, 125.2, 122.9, 111.0, 24.1.
N-(3-Methoxy-1,1-dioxo-2,3-dihydro-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acetamide (HJC-1-63)
(161) ##STR00097##
(162) To the solution of HJC-1-62 (30 mg, 0.13 mmol) in MeOH (2 mL) was added 10% NaOH (0.22 mL, 0.54 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 4 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (25 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (2 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the desired product (33 mg, 97%). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3/CD.sub.3OD 2:1) 7.84 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.82 (s, 1H), 7.42 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.99-5.01 (m, 1H), 3.69-3.72 (m, 1H), 3.38-3.40 (m, 1H), 3.37 (s, 3H), 2.05 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3/CD.sub.3OD 2:1) 170.1, 141.3, 139.5, 132.0, 127.5, 125.0, 110.9, 74.9, 57.1, 56.7, 23.7.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-4-methoxybenzamide (HJC-2-15)
(163) ##STR00098##
(164) To a solution of pyridine (395 mg, 5.0 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]-thiophen-6-ylamine (181 mg, 1.0 mmol) in 5 mL of DMF was added the solution of 4-methoxy-benzoyl chloride (170 mg, 1.0 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) dropwise at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 16 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (100 mL) and washed with H.sub.2O (10 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was washed with DCM (30 mL) to give the desired product (120 mg, 38%) as a yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.52 (s, 1H), 8.28 (s, 1H), 7.98-8.01 (m, 3H), 7.56-7.61 (m, 2H), 7.28 (d, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 7.09 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 3.85 (s, 3H).
4-Methoxy-N-(3-methoxy-1,1-dioxo-2,3-dihydro-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)benzamide (HJC-2-20)
(165) ##STR00099##
(166) To the solution of HJC-2-15 (50 mg, 0.16 mmol) in MeOH (10 mL) was added 10% NaOH (0.26 mL, 0.64 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 18 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (25 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (2 mL) and brine (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/1) to afford the desired product (40 mg, 73%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.51 (s, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.05 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.99 (d, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.68 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.09 (d, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 5.14-5.17 (m, 1H), 3.95-3.98 (m, 1H), 3.85 (s, 3H), 3.63-3.66 (m, 1H), 3.38 (s, 3H).
4-{2-[4-Chloro-2-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenylcarbamoyl)-phenoxy]-ethyl}-piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester (HJC-2-50)
(167) ##STR00100##
(168) To a solution of niclosamide (200 mg, 0.61 mmol) and PPh.sub.3 (288 mg, 1.1 mmol) in THF (5 mL) was added 4-(2-hydroxy-ethyl)-piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester (253 mg, 1.1 mmol) in THF (5 mL) and DIAD (222 mg, 1.1 mmol). The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 2 h, and then was concentrated to give the crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=3/1) to afford the desired product (300 mg, 91%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.62 (s, 1H), 8.80 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s, 1H), 8.22 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.49 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.07 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.42 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.26-3.29 (m, 4H), 2.87 (d, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.40-2.44 (m, 4H), 1.43 (s, 9H).
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)-2-(2-piperazin-1-yl-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-2-52)
(169) ##STR00101##
(170) To a solution of HJC-2-50 (300 mg, 0.56 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) was added TFA (3 mL) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 3 h, and then was concentrated. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc (250 mL) and 1 N NaHCO.sub.3 (10 mL). The organic layer was washed with H.sub.2O (10 mL) and dried with Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The organic layer was concentrated. The residue was washed with EtOAc (20 mL) to give HJC-2-52 (200 mg, 81%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.48 (s, 1H), 9.70-9.80 (bs, 1H), 8.44 (d, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 8.30 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.85 (s, 1H), 7.68 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.39 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.65-4.68 (m, 2H), 3.39-3.65 (m, 10H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.2, 154.1, 143.9, 140.9, 132.9, 130.1, 125.9, 125.7, 124.9, 124.8, 124.4, 123.4, 115.9, 64.0, 58.9, 54.3, 48.5.
(2-{2-[4-Chloro-2-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenylcarbamoyl)-phenoxy]-ethoxy}-ethyl)-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (HJC-2-56)
(171) ##STR00102##
(172) To a solution of niclosamide (327 mg, 1.0 mmol) and PPh.sub.3 (524 mg, 2.0 mmol) in THF (5 mL) was added [2-(2-hydroxy-ethoxy)-ethyl]-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (410 mg, 2.0 mmol) in THF (5 mL) and DIAD (404 mg, 2.0 mmol). The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 2 h, and then was concentrated to give the crude product. This residue was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/1) to afford the desired product (480 mg, 93%) as a white solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.61 (s, 1H), 8.87 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.21 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 7.49 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.10 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.65-4.68 (m, 1H), 4.45-4.47 (m, 2H), 3.87-3.90 (m, 2H), 3.51-3.53 (m, 2H), 3.20-3.25 (m, 2H), 1.40 (s, 9H).
2-[2-(2-Amino-ethoxy)-ethoxy]-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)benzamide (HJC-2-58)
(173) ##STR00103##
(174) To a solution of HJC-2-56 (400 mg, 0.78 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) was added TFA (2.5 mL) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 3 h, and then was concentrated. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc (300 mL) and 1 N NaHCO.sub.3 (10 mL). The organic layer was washed with H.sub.2O (10 mL) and dried with Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The organic layer was concentrated. The residue was washed with EtOAc (20 mL) to give HJC-2-58 (280 mg, 87%) as a pale yellow solid. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.59 (s, 1H), 8.63 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.43 (s, 1H), 8.29 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.97 (s, 1H), 7.78-7.83 (m, 2H), 7.68 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.42 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.48-4.52 (m, 2H), 3.86-3.89 (m, 2H), 3.58-3.62 (m, 2H), 2.86-2.90 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.2, 155.4, 143.0, 140.7, 133.8, 130.6, 125.5, 124.7, 123.6, 123.4, 122.5, 122.0, 116.4, 69.5, 68.2, 66.7, 38.3.
Pyridine-2-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (HJC-3-20)
(175) ##STR00104##
(176) To a solution of pyridine-2-carboxylic acid (148 mg, 1.2 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (181 mg, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of DCM was added DIPEA (388 mg, 3.0 mmol). HBTU (570 mg, 1.5 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 24 h and then was concentrated. The residue was dissolved in DMF (10 mL). The solution was added to the stirring water (50 mL) dropwise. A yellow solid was formed. The solid was filtered and washed with H.sub.2O (50 mL). 130 mg of the desired product was obtained as a yellow solid (45% yield). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 11.17 (s, 1H), 8.77 (d, 1H, J=4.2 Hz), 8.46 (s, 1H), 8.20 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.19 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.08-8.11 (m, 1H), 7.70-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.58-7.61 (m, 2H), 7.31 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.3, 149.3, 148.6, 141.0, 138.3, 137.1, 132.8, 130.3, 127.3, 126.4, 126.0, 124.6, 122.8, 112.6.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acetamide (HJC-3-61)
(177) ##STR00105##
(178) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-20 by using cyanoacetic acid as reactant. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (81% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, acetone-d6) 9.96 (s, 1H), 8.12 (s, 1H), 7.76-7.79 (m, 1H), 7.54 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.50 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 6.99 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 3.90 (s, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, acetone-d6) 162.4, 141.8, 139.1, 133.0, 131.5, 127.7, 127.2, 124.3, 115.2, 112.8, 27.5.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-nicotinamide (HJC-3-76)
(179) ##STR00106##
(180) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-20 by using pyridine-3-carboxylic acid as reactant. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (52% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.87 (s, 1H), 9.13 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.79 (t, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.32 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.27 (s, 1H), 7.99-8.00 (m, 1H), 7.59-7.63 (m, 3H), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.6, 152.5, 148.8, 141.3, 137.1, 135.6, 132.8, 130.3, 130.0, 126.5, 126.1, 124.3, 123.6, 112.4.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-isonicotinamide (HJC-3-80)
(181) ##STR00107##
(182) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-20 by using pyridine-4-carboxylic acid as reactant. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (56% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.92 (s, 1H), 8.81-8.82 (m, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.00 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.88 (t, 2H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.6, 150.4, 141.3, 141.1, 137.1, 132.8, 130.4, 126.5, 126.3, 124.5, 121.6, 112.6.
Quinoline-3-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (HJC-3-91)
(183) ##STR00108##
(184) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-20 by using quinoline-3-carboxylic acid as reactant. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (48% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 11.25 (s, 1H), 9.08 (d, 1H, J=4.2 Hz), 8.31 (s, 1H), 8.18 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.14 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.93-7.95 (m, 1H), 7.85-7.88 (m, 1H), 7.79 (d, 1H, J=4.2 Hz), 7.70-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.63-7.65 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 166.7, 151.0, 149.7, 142.4, 139.1, 133.1, 131.6, 130.7, 128.5, 127.7, 127.2, 126.3, 125.1, 124.8, 124.7, 120.0, 113.3, 113.2.
2-Bromo-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-isonicotinamide (HJC-3-95)
(185) ##STR00109##
(186) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-20 by using 2-bromo-isonicotinic acid as reactant. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (82% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.96 (s, 1H), 8.63 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 8.23 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H), 7.97-7.99 (m, 1H), 7.91 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 7.61-7.63 (m, 2H), 6.33 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.9, 151.3, 144.4, 141.8, 140.8, 137.1, 132.8, 130.5, 126.5, 126.5, 125.9, 124.6, 121.6, 112.6.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-phenyl-isonicotinamide (HJC-4-30)
(187) ##STR00110##
(188) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-20 by using 2-phenyl-isonicotinic acid as reactant. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (46% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.97 (s, 1H), 8.89 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.28 (s, 1H), 8.19 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 8.03-8.05 (m, 1H), 7.82 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 7.63 (d, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.56 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.51 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.6, 156.9, 150.4, 142.6, 141.1, 138.1, 137.1, 132.8, 130.4, 129.6, 128.9, 126.8, 126.5, 126.3, 124.6, 120.5, 118.0, 112.7.
2-(3-Aminopropoxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-3-8)
(189) ##STR00111##
(190) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 52% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.40 (bs, 1H), 8.61 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.45 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.31 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.93 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.69-7.83 (m, 2H), 7.70 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.36 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.42 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.96 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 2.08-2.13 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.7, 154.9, 143.2, 140.7, 133.4, 130.4, 125.2, 124.9, 123.8, 123.6, 123.2, 122.5, 115.7, 66.8, 36.1, 26.5.
2-(5-Amino-pentyloxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)benzamide (HJC-3-89)
(191) ##STR00112##
(192) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a white solid (two steps, 73% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.54 (s, 1H), 8.68 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.43 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.29-8.31 (m, 1H), 7.97 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.66-7.68 (m, 3H), 7.38 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.35 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.74-2.76 (m, 2H), 1.84-1.89 (m, 2H), 1.55-1.60 (m, 2H), 1.42-1.55 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.3, 155.3, 143.0, 140.7, 133.6, 130.5, 125.1, 124.7, 123.6, 123.0, 122.5, 121.8, 115.9, 69.8, 38.6, 27.7, 26.5, 22.1.
2-(2-Amino-ethoxy)-5-chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)benzamide (HJC-3-93)
(193) ##STR00113##
(194) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 40% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, acetone-d6) 10.85 (s, 1H), 8.19 (s, 1H), 8.13-8.15 (m, 1H), 8.06 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.55-7.59 (m, 2H), 7.51-7.52 (m, 1H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 6.99 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 4.52 (t, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 3.80 (t, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 1.92-1.96 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.4, 154.8, 141.2, 137.1, 132.6, 132.1, 130.1, 129.5, 126.4, 125.8, 125.8, 124.6, 124.1, 116.0, 112.1, 71.2, 40.4.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(2-piperazin-1-yl-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-4-13)
(195) ##STR00114##
(196) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 48% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.71 (s, 1H), 8.52 (s, 1H), 8.21 (s, 1H), 7.87-7.89 (m, 1H), 7.69 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.58-7.63 (m, 3H), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.26 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.24 (t, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 2.96 (t, 4H, J=4.8 Hz), 2.82 (t, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 2.62-2.64 (m, 4H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.6, 154.6, 141.1, 137.2, 132.9, 132.0, 130.2, 129.1, 126.6, 126.0, 126.0, 124.6, 123.8, 115.2, 111.9, 66.9, 55.8, 49.4, 42.9.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(piperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-4-15)
(197) ##STR00115##
(198) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 52% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.73 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 7.81-7.82 (m, 1H), 7.58-7.63 (m, 3H), 7.54-7.61 (m, 1H), 7.29-7.31 (m, 2H), 4.72-4.73 (m, 1H), 3.03-3.07 (m, 2H), 2.87-2.90 (m, 2H), 1.98-2.01 (m, 2H), 1.74-1.77 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.2, 152.8, 141.3, 137.2, 132.9, 131.4, 130.2, 128.9, 128.2, 126.6, 125.9, 124.6, 123.6, 116.7, 111.6, 71.7, 41.1, 28.5.
2-(3-Aminopropoxy)-5-chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)benzamide (HJC-4-16)
(199) ##STR00116##
(200) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 51% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.76 (s, 1H), 8.31 (s, 1H), 7.78-7.80 (m, 1H), 7.75 (s, 2H), 7.57-7.64 (m, 4H), 7.31 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.18 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.95 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.00-2.02 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.3, 154.3, 141.3, 137.2, 132.8, 131.6, 130.2, 128.8, 126.8, 126.6, 125.9, 124.3, 123.8, 114.8, 111.8, 66.0, 36.5, 26.5.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(2-methylaminoethoxy)benzamide (HJC-4-28)
(201) ##STR00117##
(202) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a white solid (two steps, 43% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.77 (s, 1H), 8.36-8.38 (m, 1H), 8.21 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.44-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.35 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.21-7.22 (m, 1H), 6.98 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.67 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 4.31 (t, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 3.18 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 2.64 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.6, 155.2, 141.8, 137.6, 133.3, 132.5, 132.4, 129.6, 127.4, 126.0, 124.5, 123.3, 114.3, 114.1, 68.3, 50.8, 36.5.
2-(4-Aminobutoxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-4-31)
(203) ##STR00118##
(204) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a white solid (two steps, 46% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 8.70 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.46 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.30-8.32 (m, 1H), 7.97 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.68-7.70 (m, 1H), 7.40 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.40 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.81 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 1.87-1.90 (m, 2H), 1.64-1.67 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.4, 155.2, 143.0, 140.8, 133.7, 130.6, 125.2, 124.8, 123.8, 123.2, 122.6, 121.9, 116.0, 69.3, 38.6, 25.2, 24.0.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(2-morpholin-4-yl-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-9)
(205) ##STR00119##
(206) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a white solid (67% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.72 (s, 1H), 8.18 (s, 1H), 7.90 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.73 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.58-7.62 (m, 3H), 7.27-7.32 (m, 2H), 4.26-4.28 (m, 2H), 3.43-3.45 (m, 4H), 2.74-2.76 (m, 2H), 2.42-2.50 (m, 4H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.4, 154.8, 141.0, 137.2, 132.8, 132.1, 130.2, 129.2, 126.5, 126.0, 125.5, 124.7, 124.1, 115.4, 112.1, 66.7, 66.0, 56.6, 53.3.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)-2-(2-dimethylamino-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-57)
(207) ##STR00120##
(208) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (50% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.59 (s, 1H), 8.76 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.33 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.22 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.20 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.48 (dd, 1H, J=2.4, 8.4 Hz), 7.06 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.36 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.80 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.26 (s, 6H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.8, 155.5, 143.4, 141.4, 133.9, 132.6, 127.6, 125.0, 123.8, 123.5, 123.0, 122.3, 115.1, 68.6, 57.8, 45.8.
2-(2-Bromoethoxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-3-64)
(209) ##STR00121##
(210) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (75% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.51 (s, 1H), 8.62 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.45 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.28-8.30 (m, 1H), 7.97 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.68-7.70 (m, 1H), 7.40 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 4.70 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 3.92 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.2, 154.6, 143.2, 140.7, 133.8, 130.7, 125.8, 124.8, 123.8, 123.6, 122.8, 122.3, 116.4, 69.9, 30.9.
5-Chloro-2-(2-dimethylaminoethoxy)-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)benzamide (HJC-3-69)
(211) ##STR00122##
(212) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (62% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.77 (s, 1H), 8.41 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 8.24 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 7.99 (s, 1H), 7.43-7.45 (m, 1H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.20 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 6.97 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.64 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 4.26 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 2.84 (t, 2H, J=4.2 Hz), 2.39 (s, 6H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.4, 155.3, 141.9, 137.6, 133.4, 132.5, 132.5, 129.7, 127.5, 126.0, 124.5, 123.0, 114.3, 66.1, 57.9, 45.2.
2-(2-Bromo-ethoxy)-5-chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)benzamide (HJC-3-77)
(213) ##STR00123##
(214) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (75% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.59 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 7.89 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.70 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.58-7.61 (m, 3H), 7.26-7.31 (m, 2H), 4.47 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 3.87 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.4, 154.1, 141.1, 137.2, 132.8, 132.0, 130.2, 129.3, 126.5, 126.2, 125.9, 125.0, 123.9, 115.5, 112.0, 69.1, 31.1.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-methylpiperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-3-81)
(215) ##STR00124##
(216) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (57% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.33 (s, 1H), 8.63 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.44 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.30 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.91 (s, 1H), 7.64 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.44 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.69-4.71 (m, 1H), 2.67-2.69 (m, 2H), 2.16 (s, 3H), 2.14-2.16 (m, 2H), 2.03-2.05 (m, 2H), 1.79-1.81 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.6, 154.0, 143.1, 140.5, 133.5, 130.6, 125.2, 124.9, 123.7, 123.6, 123.3, 122.2, 117.4, 75.8, 52.6, 45.4, 30.5.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(1-methyl-piperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-3-82)
(217) ##STR00125##
(218) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (39% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.63 (s, 1H), 8.22 (s, 1H), 7.85 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.58-7.61 (m, 3H), 7.51-7.53 (m, 1H), 7.27-7.30 (m, 2H), 4.53-4.55 (m, 1H), 2.42-2.44 (m, 2H), 2.19-2.21 (m, 2H), 2.06 (s, 3H), 1.89-1.91 (m, 2H), 1.69-1.71 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.1, 153.2, 141.2, 137.2, 132.8, 131.5, 130.1, 128.8, 128.0, 126.6, 125.8, 124.4, 123.5, 116.8, 111.6, 79.2, 51.6, 45.8, 30.0.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitro-phenyl)-2-(2-fluoro-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-98)
(219) ##STR00126##
(220) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a white solid (86% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.53 (s, 1H), 8.66 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 8.43 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 8.28-8.30 (m, 1H), 7.98 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.69-7.70 (m, 1H), 7.40 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.82-4.91 (m, 2H), 4.60-4.66 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.2, 155.0, 143.1, 140.7, 133.7, 130.7, 125.7, 124.8, 123.6, 123.3, 122.7, 122.0, 116.3, 81.6 (d, J=166 Hz), 69.6 (d, J=19 Hz).
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(2-fluoroethoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-99)
(221) ##STR00127##
(222) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-14. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (77% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.63 (s, 1H), 8.21 (s, 1H), 7.85-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.68 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.58-7.61 (m, 3H), 7.26-7.31 (m, 2H), 4.74-4.83 (m, 2H), 4.37-4.43 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.6, 154.3, 141.1, 137.2, 132.8, 131.9, 130.2, 129.1, 126.6, 126.4, 125.9, 124.9, 123.7, 115.5, 111.7, 82.1 (d, J=166 Hz), 68.5 (d, J=18 Hz).
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-[2-(4-methanesulfonylpiperazin-1-yl)-ethoxy]benzamide (HJC-2-55)
(223) ##STR00128##
(224) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-31. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (100% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.71 (s, 1H), 8.54 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.45 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.28 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.97 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.68 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.43 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.48 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.81-2.87 (m, 6H), 2.66 (s, 3H), 2.48-2.51 (m, 4H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.1, 155.4, 143.4, 140.7, 133.6, 130.4, 125.5, 124.8, 124.4, 124.0, 123.1, 122.8, 117.0, 67.3, 55.3, 51.7, 45.1, 33.3.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-methanesulfonylpiperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-4-24)
(225) ##STR00129##
(226) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-31. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (95% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 9.99 (s, 1H), 8.87 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.21-8.23 (m, 1H), 8.16 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.48-7.50 (m, 1H), 7.03 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.64-4.66 (m, 1H), 3.66-3.69 (m, 2H), 3.04-3.09 (m, 2H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 2.21-2.24 (m, 2H), 2.03-2.07 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.9, 153.4, 143.5, 140.8, 133.8, 132.8, 128.2, 125.1, 124.7, 123.8, 122.8, 121.6, 116.3, 76.0, 43.7, 36.0, 30.9.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-(2-methanesulfonylaminoethoxy)benzamide (HJC-4-26)
(227) ##STR00130##
(228) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-31. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (89% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.54 (s, 1H), 8.65 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.45 (s, 1H), 8.30 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.97 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.38-7.40 (m, 2H), 4.42-4.45 (m, 2H), 3.43-3.45 (m, 2H), 2.89 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.4, 155.0, 143.1, 140.9, 133.6, 130.7, 125.4, 124.8, 123.9, 123.6, 122.9, 122.2, 115.9, 69.3, 41.3, 38.3.
HJC-4-35-1 and HJC-4-35-2
(229) ##STR00131##
(230) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-31 and HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, HJC-4-35-1: 36% yield; HJC-4-35-2: 31% yield); HJC-4-35-1: .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.20 (s, 1H), 8.73 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.21 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.43-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.32-7.34 (m, 1H), 7.03 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.53-4.57 (m, 1H), 3.42 (s, 6H), 3.17-3.19 (m, 2H), 2.70-2.74 (m, 2H), 2.15-2.17 (m, 2H), 1.75-1.82 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.8, 154.1, 137.5, 133.5, 132.6, 131.5, 130.2, 128.9, 127.3, 124.1, 123.7, 123.0, 116.1, 78.0, 44.8, 42.9, 33.0. HJC-4-35-2: .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, acetone-d6) 8.49 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.12 (d, 1H, J=3.6 Hz), 7.57-7.59 (m, 1H), 7.54 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.48 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.36-7.38 (m, 1H), 4.98-5.01 (m, 1H), 3.35-3.33 (m, 2H), 3.07 (s, 3H), 3.02-3.06 (m, 2H), 2.35-2.37 (m, 2H), 2.04-2.11 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, acetone-d6) 162.6, 155.0, 136.2, 133.8, 132.6, 132.3, 126.9, 125.2, 125.0, 124.6, 121.9, 120.5, 117.6, 76.4, 43.8, 39.5, 31.3, 30.6.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-(2,3-dihydroxypropoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-60)
(231) ##STR00132##
(232) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-50/HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 80% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.69 (s, 1H), 8.60 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.42 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.27-8.29 (m, 1H), 7.96 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.65-7.67 (m, 1H), 7.40 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 5.12 (d, 1H, J=3.6 Hz), 4.79 (t, 1H, J=5.4 Hz), 4.44-4.46 (m, 1H), 4.22-4.25 (m, 1H), 3.94-3.96 (m, 1H), 3.40-3.49 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.2, 155.8, 143.1, 140.9, 133.7, 130.6, 125.2, 124.7, 123.9, 123.5, 122.4, 122.3, 116.4, 72.6, 69.4, 62.6.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-[2-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)-ethoxy]benzamide (HJC-3-65)
(233) ##STR00133##
(234) To a solution of HJC-3-64 (100 mg, 0.23 mmol), KI (58 mg, 0.35 mmol) and K.sub.2CO.sub.3 (48 mg, 0.35 mmol) in acetone (5 mL) was added 1-methyl-piperazine (46 mg, 0.46 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at 75 C. for 18 h. The solution was diluted with EtOAc (100 mL), washed with 0.1 N HCl (aq.) (10 mL) and brine (10 mL). The organic layer was dried over anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, and then concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (hexane/EtOAc=1/1 to 1/3) to give the desired product as a pale yellow solid (57 mg, 55%). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.66 (s, 1H), 8.75 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.33 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 8.22 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.20-8.21 (m, 1H), 7.47-7.49 (m, 1H), 7.06 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.39 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.85 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.21-2.50 (m, 8H), 2.14 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 162.7, 155.5, 143.4, 141.4, 133.9, 132.5, 127.7, 125.0, 124.0, 123.5, 123.0, 122.4, 115.5, 68.1, 56.5, 55.0, 53.4, 46.1.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-[2-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)-ethoxy]benzamide (HJC-3-78)
(235) ##STR00134##
(236) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-65. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (77% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.70 (s, 1H), 8.17 (s, 1H), 7.89-7.90 (m, 1H), 7.73 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.58-7.62 (m, 3H), 7.26-7.31 (m, 2H), 4.25 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 2.73 (t, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 2.42-2.50 (m, 4H), 2.12-2.22 (m, 4H), 2.03 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.3, 154.9, 141.0, 137.2, 132.8, 132.2, 130.2, 129.2, 126.5, 126.0, 125.4, 124.7, 124.2, 115.4, 112.2, 66.9, 56.2, 54.5, 52.7, 45.6.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-(2-piperidin-1-yl-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-79)
(237) ##STR00135##
(238) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-65. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (98% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.71 (s, 1H), 8.20 (s, 1H), 7.89 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.74 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.59-7.62 (m, 3H), 7.27-7.31 (m, 2H), 4.25 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 2.70-2.72 (m, 2H), 2.38-2.40 (m, 4H), 1.35-1.38 (m, 4H), 1.22-1.24 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 163.3, 155.0, 141.0, 137.2, 132.8, 132.2, 130.2, 129.3, 126.5, 126.0, 125.3, 124.7, 124.1, 115.4, 112.2, 66.9, 56.9, 54.1, 25.4, 23.8.
5-Chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)-2-(2-piperidin-1-yl-ethoxy)benzamide (HJC-3-84)
(239) ##STR00136##
(240) The general procedure was the same as HJC-3-65. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (91% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.80 (s, 1H), 8.54 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.45 (s, 1H), 8.28-8.30 (m, 1H), 7.97 (s, 1H), 7.66-7.68 (m, 1H), 7.42 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.44-4.46 (m, 2H), 2.68-2.70 (m, 2H), 2.30-2.32 (m, 4H), 1.22-1.24 (m, 6H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.1, 155.6, 143.3, 140.9, 133.7, 130.5, 125.5, 124.7, 124.5, 123.5, 123.0, 122.6, 117.2, 67.6, 56.6, 53.9, 25.3, 23.7.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-4-methoxybenzenesulfonamide (HJC-3-68)
(241) ##STR00137##
(242) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62. Obtained as a yellow solid (46% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 7.74 (d, 2H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.69 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.66 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.53 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.42 (d, 1H, J=1.2 Hz), 7.26-7.28 (m, 1H), 7.18 (d, 2H, J=9.0 Hz), 3.90 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 164.0, 137.2, 137.1, 135.6, 133.1, 132.8, 132.0, 130.7, 129.1, 126.9, 123.8, 114.8, 56.0.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-4-methylbenzenesulfonamide (HJC-3-70)
(243) ##STR00138##
(244) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62. Obtained as a yellow solid (30% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 7.65-7.72 (m, 5H), 7.54 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.49 (d, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.26-7.28 (m, 1H), 2.46 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 145.9, 137.2, 135.3, 135.0, 133.2, 133.0, 132.0, 130.1, 128.2, 127.0, 123.8, 21.2.
3-(6-Bromo-pyridin-2-yl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-acrylamide (HJC-3-71)
(245) ##STR00139##
(246) To a solution of HJC-3-61 (100 mg, 0.40 mmol) and 6-bromo-pyridine-2-carbaldehyde (112 mg, 0.60 mmol) in EtOH (5 mL) was added piperidine (3 mg, 0.04 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at 90 C. for 0.5 h. A yellow suspension formed during the reaction. The solid was filtered and washed with H.sub.2O. 120 mg of the desired product was obtained as a yellow solid (72% yield). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.94 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s, 1H), 8.14 (s, 1H), 7.98 (t, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.91-7.93 (m, 2H), 7.84 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 160.7, 150.8, 147.2, 141.3, 140.8, 140.6, 137.1, 132.7, 130.9, 130.5, 126.7, 126.6, 126.6, 124.8, 114.6, 112.8, 110.8.
2-Cyano-3-(3,4-dihydroxy-phenyl)-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-acrylamide (HJC-4-11)
(247) ##STR00140##
(248) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62. Obtained as a yellow solid (75% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.62 (s, 1H), 9.50-10.20 (bs, 2H), 8.12 (s, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.89-7.91 (m, 1H), 7.58-7.62 (m, 3H), 7.36-7.37 (m, 1H), 7.31 (d, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 6.92 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 161.9, 151.8, 151.3, 145.8, 141.0, 137.0, 132.8, 130.4, 126.4, 126.2, 125.8, 124.6, 123.1, 116.8, 116.3, 116.1, 112.7, 101.0.
2-(1-Acetylpiperidin-4-yloxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-4-22)
(249) ##STR00141##
(250) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (91% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.07 (s, 1H), 8.87 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.33 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.21-8.23 (m, 1H), 8.18 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.48-7.50 (m, 1H), 7.05 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.69-4.73 (m, 1H), 4.33-4.35 (m, 1H), 3.80-3.82 (m, 1H), 3.28 (t, 1H, J=10.8 Hz), 3.05-3.08 (m, 1H), 2.16-2.18 (m, 2H), 2.11 (s, 3H), 1.82-1.92 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 169.1, 162.9, 153.6, 143.5, 140.9, 133.9, 132.9, 128.1, 125.0, 124.5, 123.8, 122.8, 121.7, 116.2, 44.0, 39.3, 31.8, 31.0, 21.5.
2-(2-Acetylaminoethoxy)-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-4-25)
(251) ##STR00142##
(252) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (90% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 10.60 (s, 1H), 8.67 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.43 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 8.28-8.30 (m, 1H), 8.04-8.06 (m, 1H), 7.99 (d, 1H, J=3.0 Hz), 7.66-7.68 (m, 1H), 7.39 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 4.41 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.49-3.51 (m, 2H), 1.72 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 169.5, 162.2, 155.0, 143.0, 140.8, 133.6, 130.6, 125.3, 124.6, 123.5, 122.6, 121.9, 115.8, 68.6, 37.6, 22.3.
2-[2-(4-Acetylpiperazin-1-yl)-ethoxy]-5-chloro-N-(2-chloro-4-nitrophenyl)benzamide (HJC-4-27)
(253) ##STR00143##
(254) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (91% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.60 (s, 1H), 8.81 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.21-8.24 (m, 2H), 7.49-7.51 (m, 1H), 7.07 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.43 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 3.46-3.48 (m, 2H), 3.31-3.33 (m, 2H), 2.89 (t, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 2.44-2.48 (m, 4H), 2.03 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 168.8, 162.5, 155.2, 143.3, 141.1, 133.9, 132.5, 127.8, 124.8, 123.7, 123.2, 123.0, 121.9, 115.2, 67.7, 56.4, 53.6, 52.9, 46.0, 41.1, 21.3.
N-(4-Acetylamino-2-chloro-phenyl)-5-chloro-2-(piperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-4-32)
(255) ##STR00144##
(256) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-62 and HJC-1-52. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (two steps, 66% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, acetone-d6) 8.37-8.40 (m, 1H), 8.07-8.08 (m, 1H), 7.55-7.56 (m, 1H), 7.45-7.48 (m, 2H), 5.04-5.06 (m, 1H), 3.45-3.49 (m, 2H), 3.16-3.20 (m, 2H), 2.41-2.45 (m, 2H), 2.14-2.20 (m, 2H), 1.95 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, acetone-d6) 169.0, 162.5, 154.8, 137.5, 133.7, 132.2, 131.1, 127.0, 125.5, 124.5, 124.1, 120.2, 118.7, 117.4, 75.1, 43.1, 30.6, 24.2.
N-(4-Amino-2-chlorophenyl)-5-chloro-2-(piperidin-4-yloxy)benzamide (HJC-4-23)
(257) ##STR00145##
(258) The general procedure was the same as HJC-1-29. Obtained as a pale yellow solid (72% yield); .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) 9.60 (s, 1H), 7.74 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.51-7.56 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.70 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 6.55 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 5.31-5.32 (m, 2H), 4.84-4.86 (m, 1H), 3.26-3.29 (m, 3H), 3.00-3.02 (m, 2H), 2.13-2.15 (m, 2H), 1.90-1.92 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d6) 162.5, 152.9, 147.7, 131.6, 129.6, 127.3, 126.9, 126.6, 124.9, 122.5, 116.7, 113.3, 112.7, 71.6, 40.9, 27.6.
(259) ##STR00146##
The following general procedure was used to generate HJC0371 analogues:
(260) ##STR00147##
(261) To the solution of 2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acetamide (0.1 mmol) and the appropriate aldehyde (0.15 mmol) in EtOH (4 mL) was added ammonium acetate (0.05 mmol) was stirred at room temperature for 16 h. The separated solid was isolated by simple filtration and dried.
3-(2-Bromophenyl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-7)
(262) ##STR00148##
(263) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 226-227 C.) in 94% yield. HPLC purity 98.4% (t.sub.R=20.19 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.90 (s, 1H), 8.44 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H), 8.03 (t, 1H, J=1.2 Hz), 7.92-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.86-7.88 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.65 (m, 3H), 7.53-7.56 (m, 1H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.0, 150.5, 140.4, 137.0, 133.6, 133.4, 132.7, 132.1, 130.6, 130.1, 128.4, 126.7, 126.5, 125.1, 124.5, 115.0, 113.1, 111.0. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12BrN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 414.9747 (M+H).sup.+. found 414.9746.
3-(4-Bromophenyl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-8)
(264) ##STR00149##
(265) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 289-290 C.) in 90% yield. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.86 (s, 1H), 8.32 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.90-7.94 (m, 3H), 7.85 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.61-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.9, 150.4, 140.7, 137.1, 132.8, 132.5, 131.9, 130.9, 130.5, 126.5, 126.5, 126.5, 126.4, 124.7, 115.7, 112.7, 107.5. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12BrN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 414.9747 (M+H).sup.+. found 414.9746.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2-hydroxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-9)
(266) ##STR00150##
(267) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 284-285 C.) in 96% yield. HPLC purity 99.2% (t.sub.R=20.92 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 13.29 (s, 1H), 9.33 (s, 1H), 8.60 (s, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.85 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.69-7.71 (m, 1H), 7.59-7.62 (m, 3H), 7.27-7.33 (m, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.5, 155.6, 153.5, 142.1, 140.5, 137.4, 133.5, 132.6, 130.3, 126.7, 126.2, 124.3, 124.0, 119.7, 118.4, 115.0, 111.8. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.13N.sub.2O.sub.4S, 353.0591 (M+H).sup.+. found 353.0590.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(3-hydroxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-10)
(268) ##STR00151##
(269) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 262-263 C.) in 96% yield. HPLC purity 98.1% (t.sub.R=17.84 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.81 (s, 1H), 9.99 (s, 1H), 8.23 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.60-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.44 (s, 1H), 7.40-7.41 (m, 2H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.02-7.04 (m, 1H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.2, 157.8, 151.7, 140.8, 137.1, 132.9, 132.8, 130.5, 130.4, 126.5, 126.4, 124.7, 121.6, 120.1, 116.0, 115.9, 112.7, 106.4. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.13N.sub.2O.sub.4S, 353.0591 (M+H).sup.+. found 353.0595.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(4-hydroxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-11)
(270) ##STR00152##
(271) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 306-307 C.) in 99% yield. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.66 (s, 2H), 8.20 (s, 1H), 8.13 (t, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.95 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.90-7.91 (m, 1H), 7.58-7.62 (m, 2H), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 6.97-6.99 (m, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 162.3, 161.7, 151.5, 141.0, 137.0, 133.3, 132.8, 130.4, 126.5, 126.2, 124.6, 122.7, 116.8, 116.4, 112.7, 101.5. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.13N.sub.2O.sub.4S, 353.0591 (M+H).sup.+. found 353.0595.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2-methoxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-12)
(272) ##STR00153##
(273) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 223-224 C.) in 96% yield. HPLC purity 96.0% (t.sub.R=19.66 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.80 (s, 2H), 8.52 (s, 1H), 8.15 (d, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 8.07 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.59-7.64 (m, 3H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.23 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.16 (t, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 3.92 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.0, 158.5, 146.6, 140.7, 137.0, 134.8, 132.8, 130.5, 128.6, 126.5, 125.0, 120.8, 120.3, 116.0, 113.0, 112.1, 106.9. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.19H.sub.15N.sub.2O.sub.4S, 367.0747 (M+H).sup.+. found 367.0750.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(4-methoxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-13)
(274) ##STR00154##
(275) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 275-276 C.) in 93% yield. HPLC purity 97.0% (t.sub.R=19.57 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.71 (s, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.13 (d, 1H, J=1.2 Hz), 8.03-8.05 (m, 2H), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.59-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.18-7.19 (m, 2H), 3.88 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 163.0, 161.5, 151.2, 140.9, 137.0, 132.8, 130.4, 126.5, 126.3, 124.6, 124.2, 116.6, 115.0, 112.7, 103.0, 55.7. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.19H.sub.15N.sub.2O.sub.4S, 367.0747 (M+H).sup.+. found 367.0740.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2,4,6-trimethylphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-14)
(276) ##STR00155##
(277) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 255-256 C.) in 80% yield. HPLC purity 97.4% (t.sub.R=20.69 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.79 (s, 1H), 8.49 (s, 1H), 8.15 (d, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.93-7.95 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.00 (s, 2H), 2.28 (s, 3H), 2.27 (s, 6H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.0, 154.0, 140.6, 139.0, 137.0, 135.6, 132.8, 130.5, 129.3, 128.6, 126.5, 124.9, 114.9, 114.5, 113.0. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.21H.sub.19N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 379.1111 (M+H).sup.+. found 379.1106.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(3-nitrophenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-15)
(278) ##STR00156##
(279) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 269-270 C.) in 87% yield. HPLC purity 99.2% (t.sub.R=19.35 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.94 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.51 (s, 1H), 8.44-8.46 (m, 1H), 8.39 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 8.14 (s, 1H), 7.91-7.93 (m, 2H), 7.62-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.35 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.5, 149.4, 148.1, 140.5, 137.1, 135.9, 133.2, 132.7, 131.0, 130.6, 126.6, 124.8, 124.4, 115.3, 112.7, 109.5. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12N.sub.3O.sub.5S, 382.0492 (M+H).sup.+. found 382.0496.
2-Cyano-3-(4-dimethylaminophenyl)-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-16)
(280) ##STR00157##
(281) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 279-280 C.) in 95% yield. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.47 (s, 1H), 8.13 (t, 2H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.94 (d, 2H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.90-7.91 (m, 1H), 7.56-7.61 (m, 2H), 7.30 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 6.86 (d, 2H, J=9.0 Hz), 3.09 (s, 6H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 162.3, 153.3, 151.4, 141.3, 137.0, 133.2, 132.8, 130.2, 126.4, 125.9, 124.5, 118.5, 117.8, 112.6, 111.8, 96.8. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.20H.sub.18N.sub.3O.sub.3S, 380.1063 (M+H).sup.+. found 380.1061.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(1H-pyrrolo[2,3-b]pyridin-3-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-17)
(282) ##STR00158##
(283) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 300-301 C.) in 87% yield. HPLC purity 99.2% (t.sub.R=17.66 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 13.02 (s, 1H), 10.62 (s, 1H), 8.61 (d, 2H, J=16.2 Hz), 8.46-8.48 (m, 1H), 8.41-8.42 (m, 1H), 8.16 (m, 1H), 7.93-7.95 (m, 1H), 7.59-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.34-7.36 (m, 1H), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.8, 148.7, 145.0, 143.7, 141.1, 137.0, 132.8, 131.7, 130.3, 127.9, 126.4, 126.0, 124.5, 119.2, 118.0, 117.9, 112.7, 108.4, 98.8. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.19H.sub.13N.sub.4O.sub.3S, 377.0703 (M+H).sup.+. found 377.0701.
2-Cyano-3-(5-cyano-1H-indol-3-yl)-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-19)
(284) ##STR00159##
(285) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 288-289 C.) in 80% yield. HPLC purity 97.7% (t.sub.R=18.84 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 12.81 (s, 1H), 10.61 (s, 1H), 8.69 (d, 2H, J=5.4 Hz), 8.60 (s, 1H), 8.16 (s, 1H), 7.94-7.96 (m, 1H), 7.76 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.66-7.67 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.7, 142.7, 141.1, 137.9, 137.1, 132.8, 130.3, 127.1, 126.5, 126.1, 124.6, 124.5, 120.0, 117.8, 114.3, 112.7, 110.0, 103.8, 99.9.
2-Cyano-3-cyclohexyl-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-20)
(286) ##STR00160##
(287) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 180-181 C.) in 59% yield. HPLC purity 98.6% (t.sub.R=20.32 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.60 (s, 1H), 8.08 (d, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.85-7.87 (m, 1H), 7.61 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.58 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.52 (d, 1H, J=10.2 Hz), 7.32 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.57-2.61 (m, 1H), 1.73-1.77 (m, 4H), 1.65-1.67 (m, 1H), 1.30-1.37 (m, 4H), 1.22-1.25 (m, 1H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 163.1, 160.2, 140.6, 137.0, 132.7, 130.5, 126.5, 126.4, 124.7, 114.3, 112.8, 110.7. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.19N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 343.1111 (M+H).sup.+. found 343.1108.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-pyridin-3-yl-acrylamide (RMF-1-22)
(288) ##STR00161##
(289) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 255-256 C.) in 88% yield. HPLC purity 99.4% (t.sub.R=17.09 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.91 (s, 1H), 9.04 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.77-8.78 (m, 1H), 8.44-8.46 (m, 1H), 8.41 (s, 1H), 8.14 (t, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.91-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.65-7.68 (m, 1H), 7.62-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.5, 152.7, 151.3, 148.8, 140.6, 137.1, 136.1, 132.8, 130.6, 128.0, 126.6, 124.8, 124.3, 115.6, 112.8, 109.0. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17H.sub.12N.sub.3O.sub.3S, 338.0594 (M+H).sup.+. found 338.0598.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-pyridin-4-yl-acrylamide (RMF-1-23)
(290) ##STR00162##
(291) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 288-289 C.) in 70% yield. HPLC purity 98.8% (t.sub.R=17.15 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.97 (s, 1H), 8.83-8.85 (m, 2H), 8.35 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.83-7.84 (m, 2H), 7.62-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.2, 150.9, 149.2, 140.5, 138.8, 137.1, 132.7, 130.6, 126.7, 126.6, 124.8, 122.9, 115.0, 112.8, 111.6. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17H.sub.12N.sub.3O.sub.3S, 338.0594. found 338.0594.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2-fluoro-pyridin-3-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-24)
(292) ##STR00163##
(293) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 262-263 C.) in 95% yield. HPLC purity 97.2% (t.sub.R=17.94 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.96 (s, 1H), 8.62-8.65 (m, 1H), 8.47-8.48 (m, 1H), 8.35 (s, 1H), 8.14 (m, 1H), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.65 (m, 3H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.0, 159.9, 159.3, 151.2, 151.1, 142.5, 140.4, 140.4, 137.0, 132.7, 130.6, 126.7, 126.5, 125.0, 122.9, 115.1, 114.9, 113.0, 111.9. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17K.sub.1FN.sub.3O.sub.3S, 356.0500 (M+H).sup.+. found 356.0497.
3-(2-Chloro-pyridin-3-yl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-25)
(294) ##STR00164##
(295) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 251-252 C.) in 92% yield. HPLC purity 98.5% (t.sub.R=18.15 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.95 (s, 1H), 8.61-8.62 (m, 1H), 8.45-8.47 (m, 1H), 8.44 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H), 7.92-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.69-7.71 (m, 1H), 7.62-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.35 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 159.6, 152.3, 150.0, 146.6, 140.3, 139.0, 137.0, 132.7, 130.7, 127.4, 126.8, 126.5, 125.2, 123.7, 114.6, 113.2, 112.9. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17H.sub.11ClN.sub.3O.sub.3S, 372.0204 (M+H).sup.+. found 372.0201.
3-(2-Bromopyridin-3-yl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-26)
(296) ##STR00165##
(297) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 242-243 C.) in 96% yield. HPLC purity 97.1% (t.sub.R=18.32 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.94 (s, 1H), 8.57-8.58 (m, 1H), 8.38 (d, 2H, J=10.2 Hz), 8.15 (s, 1H), 7.92-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.71-7.73 (m, 1H), 7.63 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 7.35 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 159.6, 152.6, 148.6, 142.9, 140.3, 138.7, 137.0, 132.7, 130.7, 130.0, 126.8, 126.5, 125.2, 123.9, 114.6, 113.2, 112.8. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17H.sub.11BrN.sub.3O.sub.3S, 415.9699 (M+H).sup.+. found 415.9698.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2-methoxy-pyridin-3-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-27)
(298) ##STR00166##
(299) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 261-262 C.) in 99% yield. HPLC purity 98.3% (t.sub.R=18.81 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.86 (s, 1H), 8.41-8.44 (m, 3H), 8.14 (s, 1H), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.60-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.24-7.26 (m, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.3, 160.5, 151.2, 145.4, 140.6, 138.0, 137.0, 132.7, 130.6, 126.6, 126.5, 125.0, 117.6, 115.5, 115.0, 113.1, 109.1, 54.0. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.14N.sub.3O.sub.4S, 368.0700 (M+H).sup.+. found 368.0697.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(6-methoxy-pyridin-3-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-28)
(300) ##STR00167##
(301) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 255-256 C.) in 99% yield. HPLC purity 98.9% (t.sub.R=18.84 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.79 (s, 1H), 8.72 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.46-8.48 (m, 1H), 8.32 (s, 1H), 8.13 (d, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.60-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.10 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 3.97 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 165.8, 161.0, 152.0, 148.6, 140.7, 138.4, 137.1, 132.8, 130.5, 126.5, 126.4, 124.7, 121.8, 116.2, 112.8, 111.7, 105.0, 54.1. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.14N.sub.3O.sub.4S, 368.0700 (M+H).sup.+. found 368.00696.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(4-fluorophenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-29)
(302) ##STR00168##
(303) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 271-272 C.) in 99% yield. HPLC purity 99.4% (t.sub.R=19.53 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.83 (s, 1H), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 8.08-8.11 (m, 2H), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.49 (t, 2H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 165.1, 163.4, 161.0, 150.4, 140.7, 137.1, 133.0, 132.8, 130.5, 128.4, 126.5, 126.5, 124.7, 116.7, 116.6, 115.9, 112.7, 106.4. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12FN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 355.0547 (M+H).sup.+. found 355.0547.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2-fluorophenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-30)
(304) ##STR00169##
(305) The title compound was obtained as a light yellow solid (mp 253-254 C.) in 98% yield. HPLC purity 98.7% (t.sub.R=19.41 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.91 (s, 1H), 8.41 (s, 1H), 8.16 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.68-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.45-7.48 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.3, 160.4, 159.7, 143.4, 140.6, 137.0, 135.0, 134.9, 132.7, 130.6, 129.1, 126.6, 126.5, 125.3, 125.0, 119.9, 119.8, 116.5, 116.3, 115.4, 113.0, 109.9. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12FN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 355.0547 (M+H).sup.+. found 355.0552.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(3-fluorophenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-31)
(306) ##STR00170##
(307) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 245-246 C.) in 94% yield. HPLC purity 98.0% (t.sub.R=19.62 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.89 (s, 1H), 8.35 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.84 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.81 (d, 1H, J=9.6 Hz), 7.66-7.70 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.49-7.52 (m, 1H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 162.8, 161.2, 160.7, 150.2, 140.6, 137.1, 134.0, 133.9, 132.7, 131.5, 130.5, 126.6, 126.4, 124.8, 119.6, 119.4, 116.3, 116.2, 115.6, 112.8, 108.3. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12FN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 355.0547 (M+H).sup.+. found 355.0551.
3-(3-Bromophenyl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-32)
(308) ##STR00171##
(309) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 250-251 C.) in 98% yield. HPLC purity 99.0% (t.sub.R=20.51 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.87 (s, 1H), 8.33 (s, 1H), 8.17 (d, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.99 (t, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.83-7.84 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.59 (t, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.7, 150.0, 140.6, 137.1, 135.1, 134.0, 132.8, 132.4, 131.5, 130.5, 128.8, 126.6, 124.8, 122.3, 115.5, 112.7, 108.4. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12BrN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 414.9747 (M+H).sup.+. found 414.9753.
3-(2-Chlorophenyl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (RMF-1-33)
(310) ##STR00172##
(311) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 242-243 C.) in 91% yield. HPLC purity 98.3% (t.sub.R=19.99 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.91 (s, 1H), 8.50 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H), 8.08 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.92 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.71 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.58-7.65 (m, 4H) 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.1, 147.9, 140.5, 137.0, 134.2, 133.7, 132.7, 130.6, 130.3, 129.9, 127.9, 126.7, 126.5, 125.1, 115.1, 113.1, 111.1. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12ClN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 371.0252 (M+H).sup.+. found 371.0254.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(3-methoxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-35)
(312) ##STR00173##
(313) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 245-246 C.) in 92% yield. HPLC purity 99.4% (t.sub.R=19.64 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.84 (s, 1H), 8.31 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.59 (t, 2H, J=1.8 Hz), 7.54 (t, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.21-7.23 (m, 1H), 3.83 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.0, 159.5 151.5, 140.7, 137.1, 133.0, 132.8, 130.5, 126.5, 126.5, 124.7, 122.7, 118.6, 115.9, 115.0, 112.8, 107.0, 55.4. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.19H.sub.15N.sub.2O.sub.4S, 367.0747 (M+H).sup.+. found 367.0749.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(2-nitrophenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-36)
(314) ##STR00174##
(315) The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 254-255 C.) in 99% yield. HPLC purity 97.8% (t.sub.R=18.73 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.87 (s, 1H), 8.76 (s, 1H), 8.33 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.16 (s, 1H), 8.00 (t, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.92-7.95 (m, 2H), 7.85-7.87 (m, 1H), 7.62-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.35 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 159.7, 151.3, 147.1, 140.4, 137.1, 134.8, 132.7, 132.3, 130.7, 130.6, 128.4, 126.8, 126.5, 125.3, 125.1, 114.6, 113.1, 111.3. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12N.sub.3O.sub.5S, 382.0492 (M+H).sup.+. found 382.0493.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(4-nitrophenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-37)
(316) ##STR00175##
(317) The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 272-273 C.) in 99% yield. HPLC purity 96.5% (t.sub.R=19.38 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.97 (s, 1H), 8.47 (s, 1H), 8.44 (d, 2H, J=9.0 Hz), 8.19 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.62-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.4, 149.2, 149.0, 140.5, 137.8, 137.1, 132.8, 131.1, 130.6, 126.7, 126.6, 124.8, 124.3, 115.2, 112.8, 110.6.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl)acrylamide (RMF-1-38)
(318) ##STR00176##
(319) The title compound was obtained as a light yellow solid (mp 224-225 C.) in 99% yield. HPLC purity 97.3% (t.sub.R=19.36 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.79 (s, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H), 7.91-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.43 (s, 2H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 3.85 (s, 6H), 3.79 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.2, 152.9, 151.7, 141.4, 140.8, 137.1, 132.8, 130.5, 126.9, 126.5, 126.4, 124.7, 116.4, 112.8, 108.1, 105.1, 60.4, 56.1. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.21H.sub.19N.sub.2O.sub.6S, 427.0958 (M+H).sup.+. found 427.0957.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-(6-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)acrylamide (HJC-5-88)
(320) ##STR00177##
(321) The title compound was obtained as a light white solid (mp 221-222 C.) in 97% yield. HPLC purity 97.3% (t.sub.R=18.38 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.89 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s, 1H), 8.14 (d, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 7.90-7.93 (m, 2H), 7.70 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.61-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.46 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 2.57 (s, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.2, 158.7, 149.3, 149.1, 140.7, 137.8, 137.1, 132.8, 130.5, 126.5, 126.5, 126.2, 124.7, 124.6, 115.2, 112.7, 109.4, 23.8. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.14N.sub.3O.sub.3S, 352.0750 (M+H).sup.+. found 352.0750.
3-(3-Chlorophenyl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (HJC-5-89)
(322) ##STR00178##
(323) The title compound was obtained as a light orange solid (mp 234-235 C.) in 97% yield. HPLC purity 96.5% (t.sub.R=20.34 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.88 (s, 1H), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.13 (d, 1H, J=0.6 Hz), 8.04 (s, 1H), 7.96 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.90-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.70-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.67 (m, 3H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.7, 150.0, 140.6, 137.1, 133.9, 133.8, 132.8, 132.2, 131.3, 130.5, 129.5, 128.6, 126.6, 124.8, 115.6, 112.8, 108.4. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.12ClN.sub.2O.sub.3S, 371.0252 (M+H).sup.+. found 371.0255.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-3-pyridin-2-yl-acrylamide (HJC-5-90)
(324) ##STR00179##
(325) The title compound was obtained as a light yellow solid (mp 234-235 C.) in 98% yield. .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.92 (s, 1H), 8.82 (d, 1H, J=3.6 Hz), 8.29 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H), 8.02-8.05 (m, 1H), 7.92-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.88 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.58-7.59 (m, 1H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 161.1, 150.2, 149.8, 149.3, 140.7, 137.7, 137.1, 132.8, 130.5, 127.5, 126.5, 124.8, 115.2, 112.8, 109.6. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17H.sub.12N.sub.3O.sub.3S, 338.0599 (M+H).sup.+. found 338.0599.
2-Cyano-3-(2,6-difluorophenyl)-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (HJC-5-91)
(326) ##STR00180##
(327) The title compound was obtained as a light orange solid (mp 253-254 C.) in 97% yield. HPLC purity 96.0% (t.sub.R=19.26 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.97 (s, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.14 (s, 1H), 7.91-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.70-7.73 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.34-7.38 (m, 3H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.4, 159.5, 158.7, 140.4, 140.1, 137.0, 134.3, 132.7, 130.6, 126.7, 126.5, 125.1, 115.7, 114.3, 113.1, 112.6, 112.4, 110.4, 110.3, 110.2. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.11F.sub.2N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 373.0453 (M+H).sup.+. found 373.0451.
EXAMPLE 2
Anti-Cancer Properties of Compounds
(328) In Vitro Determination of Effects of Synthesized Compounds on Cancer Cell Proliferation.
(329) Cancer cells (breast cancer cell lines MCF-7, MDA-MB-361, SKBR3 and MDA-MB-231, pancreatic cancer cell lines AsPC-1. BxPC3 and Panc-1) were seeded in 96-well plates at a density of 1000-2000 cells/well and treated with DMSO, 0.01, 0.1, 1, 5, 10, and 100 mM of STAT3 individual inhibitors for 72 hrs. Proliferation was measured by treating cells with the 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)-5-(3-carboxymethoxyphenyl)-2-(4-sulfophenyl)-2H-tetrazo-lium) (MTS) in a CellTiter 96t AQueous Non-Radioactive Cell Proliferation Assay kit from Promega, Madison, Wis., USA). Absorbance of all wells was determined by measuring OD at 550 nm after 1 hr incubation at 37 C. on a 96-well iMark Microplate Absorbance Reader (BioRad, Hercules, Calif.). Each individual compound was tested in quadruplicate wells for each concentration, and the results were reported as mean absorptions.e.
(330) Determination of Anti-Cancer Activity Using In Vivo Animal Models.
(331) Female nude mice at 4 to 6 wk of age were obtained from MDACC ERO facility. The mice were maintained in a barrier unit with 12 hours light-dark switch room and all materials were autoclaved. Freshly harvested MDA-MB-231 cells (2.510.sup.6 cells per mouse, resuspended in 100 l PBS) were injected into the 3.sup.rd mammary fat pad of the mice, and then mice were randomly assigned into control and treatment groups (6 mice per group). Treatment started when the xenograft mammary tumors reaches a volume of 200 mm.sup.3. Selected STAT3 inhibitors and positive control drugs were dissolved in DMSO, and the individual compounds was administered to nude mice bearing xenegraft breast tumors via i.p. injection at dosing from 2.5-25 mg/kg or sterile DMSO daily, with a total injection volume of 100 ml. Control pups received an i.p. injection of 100 ml DMSO only. All experimental mice were treated with STAT3 compounds or vehicle for a consecutive 14 days. Mice were monitored daily for general health conditions (body weight, fur coat condition and posture) and toxicity (hair loss, skin rash, abdominal distension). Mice were sacrificed when the bearing xenograft tumors reach 1.5 cm diameter. Tumor volume was calculated as V=W.sup.2L/2, where L=longer diameter (mm) and W=width of short diameter (mm). All mice were sacrificed by CO.sub.2 when tumor reached the maximum size allowed, in accordance with the institutional IACUC policies. Tumor volume changes were compared with DMSO and/or other positive control drugs. At the time of sacrifice, lung, intestine, stomach, heart, brain, kidney, mammary gland, and tumor tissues were collected and fixed in 4% formalin overnight, then paraffin embedded and sectioned for Hematoxylin-Eosin staining or immunohistochemistry staining. A portion of xenograft tumor was frozen for each tumor for further biomarker studies.
(332) The inventors designed and chemically synthesized a class of new STAT3 inhibitors (Table 1; Detailed experimental procedures synthesizing these molecules are shown above in Example 1). Based on studies testing the effects of these compounds, a number of compounds such as HJC-1-23, HJC-1-25, HJC-1-30, HJC-1-36, HJC-1-49, HJC-1-52, HJC-3-8, HJC-3-9, HJC-3-69, HJC-3-71, HJC-3-81, HJC-3-89, HJC-3-91, HJC-4-16, HJC-4-28, HJC-4-30, and HJC-4-31 (Table 1) were identified that demonstrated significant inhibition on breast cancer cell proliferation (
(333) The In vivo efficacy of compound HJC-1-52 in inhibiting growth of xenograft tumors (Breast cancer MDA-MB-231) arose in mice has been carried out (
(334) Additional small molecules are being synthesized and can be biologically investigated. Additional structures are shown in
(335) TABLE-US-00001 TABLE 1 List of representative compounds that have been synthesized and pharmacologically screened. Inhibitory effects of STAT3 inhibitors on ER-positive, ER-negative breast cancer cells and pancreatic cancer cells. IC.sub.50 values (M) calculated from the proliferation data using MasterPlex ReaderFit 2010 software. Breast cancer Breast cancer ER-Positive ER-Negative MDA- MDA- Pancreatic cancer MB- MB- BxPc- Code Structure MCF-7 361 231 SKBR3 AsPC1 3H Panc-1 HJC-1-14
(336) TABLE-US-00002 TABLE 2 Effects of STAT3 inhibitors (2-14) on proliferation of human breast and pancreatic cancer cell lines. 2-13
EXAMPLE 3
Discovery of O-Alkylamino Tethered Niclosamide Derivatives as Potent and Orally Bioavailable Anticancer Agents
(337) Niclosamide has been identified to potently inhibit the activation, nuclear translocation, and transactivation of STAT3. Nevertheless, the poor aqueous solubility and bioavailability of niclosamide has hindered its further clinical development for cancer therapy. To discover new molecules with enhanced drug-like properties, a series of novel O-alkylamino tethered derivatives of niclosamide have been designed, synthesized, and biologically evaluated. Among them, compound 11 (HJC0152) has been demonstrated to significantly suppress MDA-MB-231 xenograft tumor growth in vivo (i.p. & p.o.), indicating its great potential as efficacious and orally bioavailable therapeutics for human cancer.
(338) Signal transducers and activators of transcription (STATs) are a family of transcription factors that serve as signaling transmitters for a large number of cytokines and growth factors in the regulation of critical biological processes including cell growth, proliferation, differentiation, and survival (Darnell, J. E., Jr., 1997; Bowman, T. et al., 2000; Bromberg, J. et al., 2000; Darnell, J. E., Jr., 2002; Buettner, R. et al., 2002; Yu, H. et al., 2004). Accumulating evidence has demonstrated that persistent activation of STAT3 stimulates tumor angiogenesis, promotes tumor immune evasion, and even confers resistance to apoptosis induced by conventional therapies (Becker, S. et al., 1998; Bromberg, J. F. et al., 1999; Siddiquee, K. et al., 2008; Darnell, J. E., 2005; Yue, P. et al., 2009; Haftchenary, S., 2011; Yu, H. et al., 2009). Therefore, STAT3 may be used as a therapeutic target for the treatment of various types of human cancer (Deng, J. et al., 2007; Page, B. D. et al., 2011; Debnath, B. et al., 2012).
(339) Despite significant advances in recent discovery efforts targeting STAT3, only several STAT3 inhibitors are advanced into early phase clinical trials (Debnath, B. et al., 2012). Poor physicochemical property is one of the most significant obstacles in promoting a potent agent into clinical trials (Debnath, B. et al., 2012). For example, peptide and peptidomimetics inhibitors targeting STAT3 suffer from poor cellular permeability and stability..sup.17-20 Aqueous solubility plays an essential role in drug disposition and is one of the crucial molecular properties for successful drug development. Although appropriate formulation could be used to enhance solubility and absorption, the stability and manufacturing difficulties should also be taken into consideration. In addition, oral chemotherapy is obviously a preferred administrative route in cancer treatment due to its convenience, patient compliance and cost-effectiveness (O'Neill, V. J. et al., 2002; Schott, S. et al., 2011). Niclosamide, an FDA-approved anticestodal drug, has recently been identified with significant inhibition of the activation, nuclear translocation, and transactivation of STAT3 (Ren, X. et al., 2010). It inhibits the transcription of STAT3 target genes, and induces cell growth inhibition, apoptosis, and cell cycle arrest of cancer cells with constitutively active STAT3. Nevertheless, niclosamide does not have an ideal pharmacokinetic profile due to its poor water solubility and low oral bioavailability (Elkihel, L. et al., 1994; Navab, M. et al., 2009). As shown herein, the inventors utilize rational chemical approaches to generate and identify novel derivatives of niclosamide with improved aqueous solubility and bioavailability as potential clinical candidates for cancer therapy. The inventors provide herein compounds with enhanced efficacy and improved drug-like properties as compared to niclosamide.
(340) The inventors firstly modified of the hydroxyl group on phenol ring of niclosamide by introduction of O-alkylamino side chain. The amino group-containing scaffolds are important motifs of structural tuning with the capability to form the hydrogen bonding like phenol group for selective protein binding and drug-likeness enhancement (Xiong, Y. et al., 2010). These new O-alkylamino tethered analogs may provide efficient target binding for a better potency and as free bases, these molecules can also form salts for the final target compounds to have a better aqueous solubility. As shown in Scheme 3, analogs 2-6 were conveniently prepared by Mitsunobu reaction. Alkylation of the bromide intermediate 2 with a variety of amines including heterocyclic moieties introduced basic functionalities into the molecules providing niclosamide derivatives 7 and 8. Mitsunobu coupling of niclosamide with N-Boc-protected amino alcohols followed by the Boc-deprotection afforded analogues 9-15 with diversified O-alkyamino side chains. Both linear alkyl amines and heterocyclic alkyl amines have been explored for the purpose of comparison.
(341) To examine whether the substitution of moiety groups affected biological activities of newly synthesized analogs and explore the structure-activity relationship (SAR), the inventors firstly evaluated the in vitro anticancer effects of the compounds 3-15 on the proliferation of breast cancer cell lines MCF-7 (ER-positive) and MDA-MB-231 (ER-negative and triple-negative), as well as pancreatic cancer cell lines AsPC1 and Panc-1 using MTS assays. The ability of these new analogues to inhibit the growth of cancer cells is summarized in Table 3. The results revealed that analogues 10-15 bearing the terminal amino group-containing side chain at the phenol moiety showed promising antiproliferative activities with low micromolar to nanomolar IC.sub.50 values, while the alkyl-substituted derivatives 5-9 at the terminal amino group on the same position displayed moderate to low activities. For example, new analogues 10 and 11 exhibited a similar or significantly higher potency than niclosamide. However, compound 4 with a methylated terminal amino group in 4-O-piperidinyl moiety, displayed 10-fold loss of antiproliferative activity in comparison with analogue 10. The same trend of SAR was also found for compounds 5-8, in which the dialkyl substitution at the terminal amino group resulted in significant loss of activities, while O-ethylpiperazinyl derivative 9 in contrast with 8 regained antiproliferative activity with IC.sub.50 values of 12.4 M and 8.7 M against two breast cancer cell lines MCF-7 and MDA-MB-231, respectively. The fluorinated compound 3 that was initially designed for potential PET imaging studies displayed no significant effects against the tested cancer cells.
(342) ##STR00261## ##STR00262##
(343) Further modifications of nitro group in compound 10, one of the most potent analogues identified from the first SAR exploration, were also investigated. As outlined in Scheme 4, reduction of the nitro group of the intermediate 17 with zinc dust provided the corresponding amine 18. Further treatment of 18 with methanesulfonyl chloride or acetyl chloride followed by removal of the Boc group afforded the desired products 19 and 20, respectively. As shown in Table 3, replacement of the nitro group of compound 10 with methanesulfonamide (19) or acetamide (20) resulted in a significant loss of the antiproliferative activity, indicating that the nitro moiety is fairly important for potency.
(344) ##STR00263##
(345) TABLE-US-00003 TABLE 3 Effects of niclosamide analogues on proliferation of human breast and pancreatic cancer cell lines. IC.sub.50 (M) Breast Cancer Pancreatic cancer Compd cLogP.sup.a MCF-7 MDA-MB-231 AsPC1 Panc-1 1 4.05 1.06 0.79 1.47 1.73 3 4.26 >10 >10 .sup.ND.sup.b ND 4 4.22 4.11 2.69 3.51 >10 5 3.77 >10 >10 ND ND 6 3.47 9.87 18.0 72.2 >10 7 4.73 >10 >10 ND ND 8 3.56 >10 >10 ND ND 9 3.20 12.4 8.7 ND ND 10 3.91 0.25 0.29 2.76 0.54 11 3.01 0.91 1.64 1.9 1.08 12 3.33 3.11 2.61 4.2 3.11 13 3.76 3.7 2.37 7.4 >10 14 4.15 3.49 3.1 2.08 4.67 15 2.87 9.37 5.3 >10 >10 19 2.95 >10 >10 ND ND 20 3.13 >10 5.87 ND ND .sup.acLogP: http://146.107.217.178/lab/alogps/start.html. .sup.bND: not determined.
(346) From the in vitro screening of all tested compounds, analogues 10 (HJC0125) and 11 (HJC0152) displayed an attractive anti-cancer profile and were subjected to further biological evaluation. To study the effects of these two compounds on cell growth, cellular morphological changes were examined in MDA-MB-231 breast cancer cells treated with compounds 10, 11 or niclosamide for 48 h, under light microscopy. Like niclosamide, both compounds 10 and 11 significantly inhibited cell proliferation and induced apoptosis accompanying cellular morphological changes at concentration of 1 M, 5 M, and 10 M, respectively.
(347) To evaluate water solubility and oral bioavailability, aqueous solubility of the new analogues 10 and 11 was determined by an HPLC method (Vogel, G. H., 2006). As expected, introduction of O-alkylamino tethered moiety not only enhanced anticancer activity, but also significantly increased the aqueous solubility. Both compounds 10 and 11 (in the form of HCl salt) demonstrated excellent water solubility, with a saturated concentration of 248 mg/mL and 762 mg/mL, respectively (
(348) Previous studies have demonstrated that niclosamide is a potential inhibitor of STAT3 (Ren, X. et al., 2010). To determine whether the new derivatives act as potent small-molecule inhibitors of STAT3 activation, the effect of niclosamide and compound 11 was measured on promoter activity using the cell-based transient transfection and dual luciferase reporter assays. MDA-MB-231 cells were pre-treated with niclosamide or 11 at different concentrations for 24 h. The STAT3 promoter activity in MDA-MB-231 cells was determined after transient transfecting with pSTAT3-Luc vector. As shown in
(349) To further investigate the inhibitory activity of compound 11 against STAT3 pathway, the inventors examined STAT3 phosphorylation and expression of the known STAT3 target genes in MDA-MB-231 cell line. The cells were treated with different doses of compound 11 for 24 h, and levels of total STAT3 and phosphorylated STAT3 at Tyr-705 were then examined by Western blot. As shown in
(350) Furthermore, compound 11 was further evaluated for its antitumor activity in inhibition of tumor growth in the MDA-MB-231 xenograft model. As expected, mice treated with 7.5 mg/kg of compound 11 via i.p. showed better effect in inhibiting tumor growth compared to the mice treated with 12.5 mg/kg of niclosamide (
(351) In summary, a series of novel O-alkylamino tethered derivatives of niclosamide have been designed, synthesized, and biologically evaluated. New analogues 10 and 11 were identified to exhibit a similar or significantly higher potency than niclosamide against human breast and pancreatic cancer cells. Both compounds 10 and 11 demonstrated a superior aqueous solubility, especially the compound 11, which has about 3,300-fold improvement in water solubility in comparison with niclosamide. In MDA-MB-231 cells, compound 11 inhibited STAT3 promoter activity, increased the expression of active caspase-3, inhibited cell cycle progression and promoted apoptosis. In nude mice bearing breast tumor xenografts, compound 11 significantly suppressed MDA-MB-231 xenograft tumor growth in vivo (both i.p. & p.o.). Compound 11 (HJC0152) was observed to have a remarkably improved aqueous solubility and may be used as an orally bioavailable agent for cancer therapy.
EXAMPLE 4
Identification of HJC0123, an Orally Bioavailable STAT3 Inhibitor for Cancer Therapy
(352) Systematic chemical synthesis and pharmacological evaluation of scaffolds as potent anticancer agents was performed by utilizing six privileged fragments from STAT3 inhibitors. Several molecules such as compounds 5, 12, and 19 that may act as advanced chemical leads have been identified. The most potent compound 5 (HJC0123) has demonstrated the ability to inhibit STAT3 promoter activity, downregulate phosphorylation of STAT3, increase the expression of cleaved caspase-3, inhibit cell cycle progression and promote apoptosis in breast and pancreatic cancer cells with low micromolar to nanomolar IC.sub.50 values. Furthermore, compound 5 significantly suppressed estrogen receptor (ER)-negative breast cancer MDA-MB-231 xenograft tumor growth in vivo (p.o.), indicating its great potential as an efficacious and orally bioavailable drug candidate for human cancer therapy.
(353) STAT3 (signal transducers and activators of transcription 3) is a member of a family of seven transcription factors (STATs 1, 2, 3, 4, 5a, 5b, and 6) that transmit signals from cell surface receptors to the nucleus, and are crucial for the signaling of many cytokines and growth factors that are mediators in the fundamental cellular and biological processes such as the immune response, angiogenesis, cell proliferation, differentiation, and apoptosis (Zhong, Z. et al., 1994; Darnell, J. E., Jr., 1997; Bromberg, J. F. et al., 1999; Bromberg, J. et al., 2000; Hirano, T. et al., 2000; Bowman, T. et al., 2000; Turkson, J. et al., 2000). It contains four functional domains that contribute to its oligomerization, DNA binding, Src homology 2 (SH2) dimerization, and transactivation, respectively. Once activated by extracellular signaling proteins, STAT3 is phosphorylated at a tyrosine residue 705 (Tyr-705) and phosphorylated STAT3 forms dimers via a reciprocal phosphotyrosines (pTyr)-SH2 domain interaction. Then the dimers translocate to the nucleus where they bind to specific DNA response elements and induce transcription (Johnston, P. A. et al., 2011). In contrast to the transient nature of STAT3 activation in normal cells, constitutive STAT3 activity has been observed and reported in many human solid and hematological tumors (Buettner, R. et al., 2002; Haura, E. B. et al., 2005). Aberrant STAT3 activation is found to be correlated with worse prognosis by promoting tumorigenesis, inducing tumor invasion and metastasis, and driving the malignant progression in many carcinomas. Thus, STAT3 is considered to be a promising target for prevention and treatment of cancer, thereby providing the rationale to develop novel anticancer agents targeting the STAT3 signaling pathway (Yu, H. et al., 2007; Yu, H. et al., 2004; Darnell, J. E., Jr., 2005; Darnell, J. E., Jr., 2002; Yu, H. et al., 2009; Germain, D. A., 2007; Costantino, L. et al., 2008; Siddiquee, K. et al., 2008).
(354) Over the past decade, several peptidic and non-peptidic STAT3 inhibitors that directly inhibit the different structural domains of STAT3 protein or indirectly inhibit the upstream components of the STAT3 activation (Schindler, C. W., 2002) such as PY*LKTK (Turkson, J. et al., 2001), STX-0119 (Matsuno, K. et al., 2010), and S31-201 (Siddiquee, K. et al., 2007) to inhibit STAT3 dimerization, Stattic (Schust, J. et al., 2006) to inhibit phosphorylation, CAP-1 (Turkson, J. et al., 2004) and IS3 295 (Turkson, J. et al., 2005) to inhibit DNA-binding, niclosamide (Ren, X. et al., 2010) to inhibit transcriptional function of STAT3, WP1066 (Horiguchi, A. et al., 2010) and AG490 (Iwamaru, A. et al., 2007) to inhibit the upstream Janus kinases activity have been explored (
(355) Synthesis of Compounds
(356) All commercially available starting materials and solvents were reagent grade, and used without further purification. Reactions were performed under a nitrogen atmosphere in dry glassware with magnetic stirring. Preparative column chromatography was performed using silica gel 60, particle size 0.063-0.200 mm (70-230 mesh, flash). Analytical TLC was carried out employing silica gel 60 F254 plates (Merck, Darmstadt). Visualization of the developed chromatograms was performed with detection by UV (254 nm). NMR spectra were recorded on a Brucker-600 (.sup.1H, 600 MHz; .sup.13C, 150 MHz) spectrometer. .sup.1H and .sup.13C NMR spectra were recorded with TMS as an internal reference. Chemical shifts were expressed in ppm, and J values were given in Hz. High-resolution mass spectra (HRMS) were obtained from Thermo Fisher LTQ Orbitrap Elite mass spectrometer. Parameters include the following: Nano ESI spray voltage was 1.8 kV; Capillary temperature was 275 C. and the resolution was 60,000; Ionization was achieved by positive mode. Melting points were measured on a Thermo Scientific Electrothermal Digital Melting Point Apparatus and uncorrected. Purity of final compounds was determined by analytical HPLC, which was carried out on a Shimadzu HPLC system (model: CBM-20A LC-20AD SPD-20A UV/VIS). HPLC analysis conditions: Waters Bondapak C18 (3003.9 mm); flow rate 0.5 mL/min; UV detection at 270 and 254 nm; linear gradient from 30% acetonitrile in water (0.1% TFA) to 100% acetonitrile (0.1% TFA) in 20 min followed by 30 min of the last-named solvent. All biologically evaluated compounds are >95% pure.
2-Cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acetamide (4)
(357) To a solution of cyanoacetic acid (340 mg, 4.0 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (362 mg, 2.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 was added DIPEA (774 mg, 6.0 mmol). HBTU (1.14 g, 3.0 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 28 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 (80 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give a crude product, which was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/1) to obtain the desired product (400 mg, 81%) as a yellow solid (mp 207-208 C.). HPLC purity 98.6% (t.sub.R=10.93 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.79 (s, 1H), 8.04 (s, 1H), 7.67-7.69 (m, 1H), 7.60 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.57 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.30 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 3.98 (s, 2H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 162.0, 140.7, 137.3, 132.8, 130.3, 126.7, 126.1, 123.4, 115.6, 111.4, 27.0. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.11H.sub.19N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 249.0328 (M+H).sup.+. found 249.0330.
2-Phenylquinoline-4-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (5)
(358) Compound 5 was prepared in 39% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 4. The title compound was obtained as a pale yellow solid (mp 277-278 C.). HPLC purity 99.2% (t.sub.R=32.39 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 11.29 (s, 1H), 8.44 (s, 1H), 8.38 (d, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.20 (dd, 2H, J=5.4 Hz, 13.8 Hz), 7.98 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.88 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.54-7.70 (m, 6H), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 165.8, 155.8, 147.9, 142.2, 141.2, 138.0, 137.2, 132.9, 130.5, 130.4, 130.0, 129.7, 129.0, 127.6, 127.3, 126.6, 126.3, 125.1, 124.2, 123.0, 117.1, 117.1, 112.3, 112.3. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.24H.sub.12N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 413.0954 (M+H).sup.+. found 413.0959.
(S)-2-Phenylquinoline-4-carboxylic acid (1-phenylethyl)amide (8)
(359) To a solution of 2-phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (249 mg, 1.0 mmol) and L()- methylbenzylamine (127 mg, 1.05 mmol) in 10 mL of CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 was added DIPEA (388 mg, 3.0 mmol). HBTU (569 mg, 1.5 mmol) was added at 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at r.t. for 3 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 (80 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to give a crude product, which was purified with silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane=1/3) to obtain 8 (330 mg, 94%) as a white solid (mp 157-158 C.). HPLC purity 99.8% (t.sub.R=17.22 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.03-8.07 (m, 3H), 7.97 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.71 (s, 1H), 7.67 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.28-7.48 (m, 9H), 6.78 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 5.38-5.43 (m, 1H), 1.66 (d, 3H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 166.9, 156.9, 148.7, 143.0, 142.6, 138.9, 130.3, 130.2, 129.8, 129.0, 127.8, 127.6, 127.4, 126.4, 125.0, 123.4, 116.4, 49.8, 21.9. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.24H.sub.21N.sub.2O, 353.1648 (M+H).sup.+. found 353.1653.
(S)-5-Chloro-2-hydroxy-N-(1-phenylethyl)benzamide (9)
(360) Compound 9 was prepared in 39% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 8. The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 124-125 C.). HPLC purity 97.1% (t.sub.R=19.75 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 12.22 (s, 1H), 7.28-7.48 (m, 7H), 6.93 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.55 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 5.29-5.34 (m, 1H), 1.64 (d, 3H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 168.2, 160.4, 142.3, 134.3, 129.1, 128.0, 126.3, 125.1, 123.4, 120.3, 115.3, 49.5, 21.7. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.15H.sub.15ClNO.sub.2, 276.0786 (M+H).sup.+. found 276.0790.
3-(6-Bromopyridin-2-yl)-2-cyano-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)acrylamide (10)
(361) To a solution of 4 (100 mg, 0.40 mmol) and 6-bromo-pyridine-2-carbaldehyde (112 mg, 0.60 mmol) in EtOH (5 mL) was added piperidine (3 mg, 0.04 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at 90 C. for 0.5 h. A yellow suspension formed during the reaction. The solid was filtered and washed with H.sub.2O. The desired product (120 mg, 72%) was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 219-220 C.). HPLC purity 96.0% (t.sub.R=16.57 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.94 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s, 1H), 8.14 (s, 1H), 7.98 (t, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.91-7.93 (m, 2H), 7.84 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 160.7, 150.8, 147.2, 141.3, 140.8, 140.6, 137.1, 132.7, 130.9, 130.5, 126.7, 126.6, 126.6, 124.8, 114.6, 112.8, 110.8. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.17H.sub.11BrN.sub.3O.sub.3S, 415.9699 (M+H).sup.+. found 415.9703.
5-Chloro-N-(1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-hydroxybenzamide (12)
(362) A solution of 5-chloro-2-hydroxybenzoic acid (2.0 g, 11 mmol) and 4 mL of SOCl.sub.2 in 4 mL of toluene was stirred at 110 C. overnight. The mixture was concentrated to give a crude product as a pale yellow oil. To the solution of pyridine (869 mg, 11 mmol) and 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (200 mg, 1.1 mmol) was added the solution of the acid chloride (500 mg, 2.6 mmol) in DMF (15 mL) dropwise at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at r.t. for 24 h. The mixture was added to the water solution dropwise. The yellow solid was formed and filtrated. To the mixture of the crude product in THF (8 mL) was added 1 N LiOH (2.2 mL, 2.2 mmol) at 0 C. The mixture was stirred at 0 C. for 30 min. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (50 mL) and washed with 2 N HCl (10 mL). The organic layer was separated and dried with anhydrous Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. The solution was concentrated to afford the crude product, which was washed with CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 (20 mL) to give the desired product (150 mg, 39%) as a yellow solid (mp 268-269 C.). HPLC purity 98.3% (t.sub.R=17.24 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 11.50 (s, 1H), 10.74 (s, 1H), 8.25 (s, 1H), 7.92 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.86 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.59-7.62 (m, 2H), 7.48 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 7.31 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.04 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 165.1, 156.2, 140.7, 137.1, 133.1, 132.8, 130.3, 128.6, 126.5, 126.2, 124.6, 122.8, 120.4, 119.0, 112.7. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.15H.sub.11ClNO.sub.4S, 336.0092 (M+H).sup.+. found 336.0098.
5-Chloro-N-(5-furan-2-yl-[1,3,4]oxadiazol-2-yl)-2-hydroxybenzamide (13)
(363) Compound 13 was prepared in 50% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 12. The title compound was obtained as a white solid (mp 196-197 C.). HPLC purity 96.0% (t.sub.R=18.99 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 10.11 (s, 1H), 8.13 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.02 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.64 (dd, 1H, J=2.4 Hz and 8.4 Hz), 7.49 (dd, 1H, J=2.4 Hz and 8.4 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.99 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 164.4, 158.4, 148.3, 135.2, 133.6, 130.8, 130.6, 130.2, 126.2, 125.9, 122.6, 119.7, 115.4. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.13H.sub.9ClN.sub.3O.sub.4, 306.0276 (M+H).sup.+. found 306.0274.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2,6-diphenyl-isonicotinamide (19)
(364) Compound 19 was prepared in 50% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 4. The title compound was obtained as a pale yellow solid (mp 235-236 C.). HPLC purity 97.2% (t.sub.R=22.05 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) 8.76 (s, 1H), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 8.23 (d, 4H, J=7.2 Hz), 8.14 (s, 2H) 7.93 (s, 1H), 7.41-7.55 (m, 6H), 7.40 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.13-7.15 (m, 1H), 6.26-6.28 (m, 1H). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 164.7, 156.6, 143.9, 141.1, 138.1, 137.1, 132.8, 130.4, 129.7, 129.0, 126.9, 126.6, 126.3, 124.6, 116.7, 112.7. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.26H.sub.19N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 439.1111 (M+H).sup.+. found 439.1116.
Acridine-9-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (20)
(365) Compound 20 was prepared in 39% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 4. The title compound was obtained as a yellow solid (mp 237-238 C.). HPLC purity 99.4% (t.sub.R=14.48 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 8.71 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.32 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.08-8.13 (m, 5 H), 7.97 (t, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.82 (t, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.68 (t, 2H, J=7.8 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 163.4, 147.9, 136.1, 133.9, 132.9, 131.1, 129.5, 128.0, 128.0, 125.2, 121.7, 116.5, 115.5. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.22H.sub.15N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 387.0798 (M+H).sup.+. found 387.0802.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)isonicotinamide (21)
(366) Compound 21 was prepared in 56% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 4. The title compound was obtained as a pale yellow solid (mp 251-252 C.). HPLC purity 97.0% (t.sub.R=8.81 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.92 (s, 1H), 8.81-8.82 (m, 2H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.00 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.88 (t, 2H, J=2.4 Hz), 7.62 (t, 2H, J=6.6 Hz), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 164.6, 150.4, 141.3, 141.1, 137.1, 132.8, 130.4, 126.5, 126.3, 124.5, 121.6, 112.6. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.14H.sub.11N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 287.0485 (M+H).sup.+. found 287.0488.
N-(1,1-Dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)-2-phenyl-isonicotinamide (22)
(367) Compound 22 was prepared in 46% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 4. The title compound was obtained as a pale yellow solid (mp 285-286 C.). HPLC purity 98.0% (t.sub.R=14.72 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 10.97 (s, 1H), 8.89 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.28 (s, 1H), 8.19 (d, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 8.03-8.05 (m, 1H), 7.82 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 7.63 (d, 2H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.56 (t, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.51 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.34 (d, 1H, J=6.6 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, DMSO-d.sub.6) 164.6, 156.9, 150.4, 142.6, 141.1, 138.1, 137.1, 132.8, 130.4, 129.6, 128.9, 126.8, 126.5, 126.3, 124.6, 120.5, 118.0, 112.7. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.20H.sub.15N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 363.0798 (M+H).sup.+. found 363.0791.
Quinoline-3-carboxylic acid (1,1-dioxo-1H-16-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl)amide (23)
(368) Compound 23 was prepared in 48% yield by a procedure similar to that used to prepare compound 4. The title compound was obtained as a pale yellow solid (mp 209-210 C.). HPLC purity 98.8% (t.sub.R=11.01 min). .sup.1H NMR (600 MHz, Acetone-d.sub.6) 10.29 (s, 1H), 9.03 (d, 1H, J=4.2 Hz), 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.14 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 8.03-8.05 (m, 1H), 7.83-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.79 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 7.68-7.70 (m, 1H), 7.63 (d, 1H, J=7.8 Hz), 7.57 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.04 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz). .sup.13C NMR (150 MHz, Acetone-d.sub.6) 166.7, 151.0, 149.7, 142.4, 139.1, 133.1, 131.6, 130.7, 128.5, 127.7, 127.2, 126.3, 125.1, 124.8, 124.7, 120.0, 113.3, 113.2. HRMS (ESI) calcd for C.sub.18H.sub.13N.sub.2O.sub.3S, 337.0641 (M+H).sup.+. found 337.0646.
(369) Biology
(370) In Vitro Determination of Effects of Synthesized Compounds on Cancer Cell Proliferation.
(371) Cancer cells (breast cancer cell lines MCF-7 and MDA-MB-231, pancreatic cancer cell lines AsPC-1 and Panc-1) were seeded in 96-well plates at a density of 210.sup.3 cells/well and treated with DMSO, 0.01, 0.1, 1, 5, 10, and 100 M of individual STAT3 inhibitors for 72 h. Proliferation was measured by treating cells with the 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)-5-(3-carboxymethoxyphenyl)-2-(4-sulfophenyl)-2H-tetrazolium) (MTS) in a CellTiter 96t Aqueous Non-Radioactive Cell Proliferation Assay kit (Promega, Madison, Wis., USA). Absorbance of all wells was determined by measuring OD at 550 nm after 1 h incubation at 37 C. on a 96-well iMark Microplate Absorbance Reader (BioRad, Hercules, Calif.). Each individual compound was tested in quadruplicate wells for each concentration.
(372) Molecular Docking Studies.
(373) Compound 5 was docked with the STAT3-SH2 domain using the X-ray structure (PDB code: 1BG1) and AutoDock Vina 1.1.2. Water molecules within the crystal structure were removed and polar hydrogens were added using AutoDockTools. The protein was treated as rigid. Docking runs were carried out using the standard parameters of the program for interactive growing and subsequent scoring, except for the parameters for setting grid box dimensions and center. For all of the docking studies, a grid box size of 30 30 30 , centered at coordinates 100.452 (x), 75.972 (y), and 68.790 (z) of the PDB structure.
(374) Transient Transfection and Dual Luciferase Reporter Assays.
(375) MDA-MB-231 cells were seeded in 24-well plate at a density of 510.sup.4 cells/well in RPMI-1640 medium containing 10% FBS and 1% penicillin-streptomycin. Transient transfections were performed 4 h after plating, using the method described previously (Rees, D. C. et al., 2004; Shen, Q. et al., 2008). Total amount of DNA for transfections was 0.5 g/well, including pSTAT3-Luc (95%, obtained from Panomics, Cat# LR0077) and internal control vector renilla (5%, from Promega, Madison, Wis., USA). 5 h after transfection, the cells were treated with compound 5 for 24 h, then reporter activity was evaluated using dual luciferase reporter assay kit (Promega, Madison, Wis., USA) on an Omega Microplate Luminometer (BMG LABTECH Inc., NC, USA). Relative luciferase units were the ratio of the absolute activity of firefly luciferase to that of renilla luciferase. Experiments were conducted with triplicates and results are representatives of at least 3 independent experiments.
(376) Western Blot Analysis.
(377) Protein levels were determined by Western blot using the previously described methods (Shen, Q. et al., 2008). Total cell lysates were prepared from MDA-MB-231 cells. Protein concentrations were measured using the BCA Protein Assay Reagent (Pierce, Rockford, Ill., USA). Equal amounts of total cellular protein extract (40 g) were resuspended in denaturing sample loading buffer (0.5 M Tris-HCl, pH 6.8, 10% SDS, 0.1% bromophenol blue, and 20% glycerol), separated by electrophoresis on a 10% polyacrylamide SDS-PAGE gel and then electrophoretically transferred to a nitrocellulose membrane (Thermo Scientific, IL, USA) at 100 Volts for 1 h at 4 C. The membrane was then incubated in a blocking solution containing 5% non-fat milk and 1% Tween 20 in TBS for 1 h. The membrane was then incubated with antibodies specific for: phospho-STAT3-pY705 (1:3000, Epitomics, #2236-1), STAT3 (1:2000, Cell Signaling, #4904), Caspase-3-cleaved (1:2000, Epitomics, #1476-1), Cyclin D1 (1:10000, Epitomics, #2261-1) and -actin (1:10000, Sigma, clone AC-15). An anti-rabbit or anti-mouse secondary antibody (Amersham, Piscataway, N.J.) was used at 1:4000 dilution. The Western blotted bands were visualized using ECL procedure according to the manufacturer's instructions (Amersham).
(378) In Vivo Antitumor Activity Assays.
(379) All procedures including mice and in vivo experiments were approved by the Institutional Animal Care and Use Committee (IACUC) of UT M.D. Anderson Cancer Center (MDACC). Female nude mice were obtained from MDACC and were used for orthotopic tumor studies at 4 to 6 weeks of age. The mice were maintained in a barrier unit with 12 h light-dark switch. Freshly harvested MDA-MB-231 cells (2.510.sup.6 cells per mouse, resuspended in 100 L PBS) were injected into the 3.sup.rd mammary fat pad of the mice, and then randomly assigned into 2 groups (6-7 mice per group). The mice were given 50 mg/kg compound 5 or vehicle five days per week when the tumor volume reached 200 mm.sup.3. All drugs were dissolved in 50% DMSO with 50% polyethylene glycol for in vivo administration. Body weights and tumors volume were measured daily and tumor volume was calculated according to the formula V=0.5LW.sup.2, where L=length (mm) and W=width (mm).
(380) Statistical Analysis
(381) Statistical significance was determined using student t-test in cell cycle analysis. * represents a p value less than 0.05.
(382) Abbreviations Used:
(383) FBDD, fragment-based drug design; STATs, signal transducers and activators of transcription; ER, estrogen receptor; HBTU, 2-(1H-benzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate; DIPEA, N,N-diisopropylethylamine; THF, tetrahydrofuran; SAR, Structure-Activity Relationships; RLU, Relative Luciferase Unit; MTS, 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)-5-(3-carboxymethoxyphenyl)-2-(4-sulfophenyl)-2H-tetrazolium); IC.sub.50, half maximal inhibitory concentration; PI, propidium iodide; HRMS, High-resolution mass spectrometry; HPLC, high performance liquid chromatography; TFA, trifluoroacetic acid; DMSO, dimethyl sulfoxide; TLC, thin layer chromatography; NMR, nuclear magnetic resonance; TMS, tetramethylsilane; EtOAc, ethyl acetate; DMF, dimethylformamide; PBS, phosphate-buffered saline; BCA, bicinchoninic acid; SDS-PAGE, sodium dodecyl sulfate polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis
(384) Design
(385) The inventors initiated studies with a small privileged fragment library containing six fragments selected from representative non-peptidic STAT3 inhibitors including stattic, WP1066, STX-0119, and niclosamide as potential binding pharmacophores to STAT3 (
(386) Chemistry
(387) As shown in Schemes 5 & 6, coupling of 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine (3) with cyanoacetic acid (1) or 2-phenyl-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (2) in the presence of HBTU and DIPEA in CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 generated the corresponding amides 4 and 5 in moderate to high yields. Condensation of L()--methylbenzylamine (7) with 2-phenylquinoline-4-carboxylic acid (2) or 5-chloro-2-hydroxybenzoic acid (6) in the same fashion provided new compounds 8 and 9, respectively. The synthesis of compound 10 was achieved in moderate yield via Knoevenagel condensation of 6-bromopyridine-2-carbaldehyde with the intermediate 4 in the presence of piperidine as the catalyst. The above mentioned coupling methods failed to give the desired compounds 12 and 13, which were successfully obtained by an alternative protocol in three steps. First, the carboxylic acid 6 was converted to the acid chloride by the treatment with SOCl.sub.2 in toluene at 120 C. for 16 h. After concentration, the acid chloride, which contained some ester formed from the hydroxyl group of phenol, was used directly for next step without further purification because the hydrolysis of the ester appendage afterwards could lead to the same desired product. 1,1-Dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-ylamine or 5-furan-2-yl-[1,3,4]oxadiazol-2-ylamine was then treated with the above acid chloride in the presence of pyridine as the base. The crude products were subsequently saponified using 1N LiOH (aq.) in THF to generate the desired compounds 12 and 13 in yield of 39% and 50% (three steps), respectively.
(388) ##STR00264##
(389) ##STR00265##
Biology
(390) To explore the SAR, the inventors first evaluated the in vitro anticancer effects of the compounds 4-5, 8-10 and 12-13 on the proliferation of human breast cancer cell lines MCF-7 (ER-positive) and MDA-MB-231 (ER-negative and triple-negative), as well as pancreatic cancer cell lines AsPC1 and Panc-1 using MTS assays as described in the Experimental Section. The ability of these new scaffolds to inhibit the growth of cancer cells is summarized in Table 4. It is noteworthy that most of the newly synthesized compounds described herein exhibited promising antiproliferative activity with low micromolar to nanomolar IC.sub.50 values. Among them, compounds 5, 10, and 12 possessing the 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl fragment (B1) exhibited a similar or significantly higher potency than the reference compound niclosamide. Interestingly, compound 4 containing the fragment B1 and the moiety A2 instead of the 6-bromopyridin-2-yl fragment (A3) was found inactive with a dramatic loss of antiproliferative activity in comparison with compound 10. Compounds 8 and 9 with (S)-(1-phenylethyl)amide moiety (B2) showed moderate to potent antiproliferative effects against the tested cancer cells. For example, compound 9 displayed an IC.sub.50 value of 0.9 M against ER-positive breast cancer cell line MCF-7. The salicylic amide compound 13 with the 5-furan-2-yl-[1,3,4]oxadiazol-2-yl moiety (B3) was found inactive, while compound 12 with the fragment B1 instead exhibited significant antiproliferative activity, indicating that fragment B1 rather than B3 is more favorable for the anticancer activity of molecules with the salicylic amide scaffold.
(391) TABLE-US-00004 TABLE 4 Effects of newly synthesized compounds 4-5, 8-10 and 12-13 on proliferation of human breast and pancreatic cancer cell lines.
(392) Among the active new scaffolds discussed above, compound 5 notably exhibited remarkable potency against all the tested cancer cells. Since STX-0119 with the 2-phenylquinoline-4-carboxylic acid amide fragment (A1) (Matsuno, K. et al., 2010; Song, H. et al., 2005) and stattic with the 1,1-dioxo-1H-1.sup.6-benzo[b]thiophen-6-yl fragment (B1) (Schust, J. et al., 2006) have been reported as the STAT3-SH2 domain inhibitors, the molecular docking studies of compound 5 with both A1 and B1 fragments were performed to investigate the possible conformations and the required spatial relationship between the scaffold and STAT3-SH2 domain (Becker, S. et al., 1998) using AutoDock Vina (Trott, O. et al., 2010) docking approach. Examination of the predicted binding model for 5 complexed with STAT3 revealed that the 2-phenyl group on the quinoline ring could fit effectively into the hydrophobic cleft around Ile634 (
(393) ##STR00271##
(394) TABLE-US-00005 TABLE 5 Effects of newly synthesized compounds 19-23 on proliferation of human breast and pancreatic cancer cell lines. 19-23
(395) The obtained SAR results suggest that the hydrophobic substituent at C2 of the quinoline or pyridine framework is crucial for targeting STAT3. For example, compounds 20, 21 and 23 without the 2-Ph moiety displayed moderate to low antiproliferative activity against the tested cancer cells. Instead, compound 22 with 2-Ph group in contrast with compound 21 regained antiproliferative activity with low micromolar IC.sub.50 values. Compound 19 with an additional phenyl substituent at the 6-position of pyridine ring exhibited further enhanced anticancer activity when compared with compound 22, indicating the important role of hydrophobic substituents on the quinoline and pyridine fragments.
(396) Through the SAR studies, compound 5 was been identified as having desirable antiproliferative activity and physicochemical parameters (see Table 6), and was subjected to further biological characterization. Cellular morphological change in MDA-MB-231 breast cancer cells treating with compound 5 for 48 h was examined under light microscopy. As shown in
(397) TABLE-US-00006 TABLE 6 Physicochemical parameters.sup.1-2 of selected novel STAT3 inhibitors HD HA Compound Chemical Strcture TPSA cLogP MW (nOHNH) (nON) 5
(398) To determine whether compound 5 acts as a potent small-molecule inhibitor of STAT3 activation, the inventors measured the effect of 5 on promoter activity using the cell-based transient transfection and dual luciferase reporter assays. The STAT3 promoter activity in MDA-MB-231 cells was determined after transient transfecting with pSTAT3-Luc vector. As shown in
(399) To further investigate the inhibitory activity of compound 5 against the STAT3 pathway, the inventors examined STAT3 phosphorylation and expression of the known STAT3 target genes in MDA-MB-231 cell line. The cells were treated with different doses of compound 5 for 24 h and 48 h, and levels of total STAT3 and phosphorylated STAT3 at Tyr-705 were then examined by Western blot. It was found that the total STAT3 expression in these cells was reduced after the treatment with compound 5 (
(400) Compound 5 was next evaluated for its antitumor activity in inhibition of tumor growth in the MDA-MB-231 xenograft model. MDA-MB-231 xenograft tumors were developed in immunodeficient nude mice and tumor volume was measured daily in oral gavage (p.o.) group. The inventors treated the MDA-MB-231 xenograft mice through oral administration of compound 5 (50 mg/kg) and found that the growth of xenograft tumors in mice was significantly suppressed by compound 5 (
(401) Systematic chemical synthesis and pharmacological evaluation of these scaffolds as potent anticancer agents was carried out by utilizing six privileged fragments from STAT3 inhibitors. Several molecules such as compounds 5, 12, and 19 were identified and characterized. Compound 5 was observed to have remarkable potency and was shown to inhibit STAT3 promoter activity, down-regulate phospho-STAT3, increase the expression of cleaved caspase-3, inhibit cell cycle progression, and promote apoptosis in breast and pancreatic cancer cells with low micromolar to nanomolar IC.sub.50 values. Furthermore, compound 5 significantly suppressed ER-negative breast cancer MDA-MB-231 xenograft tumor growth in vivo (p.o.), indicating that it may be used as an efficacious and orally bioavailable drug candidate for human cancer therapy.
EXAMPLE 5
Orally Active Small-Molecule STAT3 Inhibitor HJC0152 Exhibits Potent Anticancer Activity and Suppresses the Growth of Triple-Negative Breast Cancer Xenograft Tumors
(402) Materials and Methods
(403) Cells and Reagents:
(404) Breast cancer cell lines MDA-MB-231, HCC1569, and BT474 were maintained in RPMI-1640 medium (Cellgro, VA); MDA-MB-468, MDA-MB-453, T47D, and MCF-7 in DMEM (Cellgro, VA) supplemented with 10% heat-inactivated fetal bovine serum (Cellgro, VA) and 1% penicillin streptomycin (Sigma, MO); and SKBr3 in McCoy's 5A medium (Cellgro, VA). Human mammary epithelial cells (HMEC) were maintained in a serum-free medium MEBM (Lonza, Allendale, N.J.) containing MEGM SingalQuotes. MCF10A cells were maintained in DMEM/F12 HAM (Sigma, MO) containing 5% horse serum, 20 g/mL EGF, 100 g/mL cholera toxin, 10 ng/mL insulin, and 500 g/mL hydrocortisone. IL-6 was obtained from Cell Signaling Inc. (#8904, Cell Signaling, MA). Niclosamide was obtained from Spectrum Inc. (NJ, USA), and compound HJC0152 was synthesized in house (Chen, H. et al., 2013).
(405) Cell Proliferation Assay and Morphological Changes:
(406) Breast cells (MDA-MB-231, MCF10A, and HMEC) were seeded in 96-well plates at a density of 110.sup.4 cells/well in 100 L culture media and treated with DMSO; or 1, 5, and 10 M of individual STAT3 inhibitors. Proliferation was measured by treating cells with 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)-5-(3-carboxymethoxyphenyl)-2-(4-sulfophenyl)-2H-tetrazolium, MTS) from a CellTiter 96t AQueous Non-Radioactive Cell Proliferation Assay Kit (Promega, Madison, Wis.). Absorbance was determined by measuring OD at 560 nm after 1 h incubation at 37 C. on a 96-well plate reader. Each compound was tested in quadruplicate wells for 3 concentrations. For comparison of morphological changes, MDA-MB-231 cells were seeded in 6-well plates at a density of 210.sup.5 cells/well and maintained in RPMI-1640 medium overnight at 37 C. in a humidified atmosphere of 95% air and 5% CO.sub.2. The cells were then treated with vehicle or individual compounds. Growth media was removed 48 h after treatment and replaced with 1PBS. Images were taken using Olympus BX41 microscope.
(407) Colony Formation Assay:
(408) MDA-MB-468 and MDA-MB-231 cells were seeded in 6-well plates with a density of 800-3000 cells/well, respectively. After 24 h, the cells were treated with HJC0152, niclosamide (0.625 M, 1.25 M, 2.5 M, 5 M, and 10 M), or DMSO as vehicle. The culture media with the compounds were changed every 72 h. After two weeks, the wells were washed twice with PBS buffer and 2 mL of 0.01% crystal violet staining buffer was added and incubated for 10 min. The wells were then washed with PBS for 5 min for three times, and allowed to dry. Photographs were then taken and the density of the entire culture well area was digitally measured using the GelCount instrument (Oxford Optronix, UK). Experiments were performed in triplicate and the density data were analyzed with one-way ANOVA using GraphPad Prizm 6 software. Error bars represent standard deviation.
(409) Transient Transfection of STAT3 Expression Vector:
(410) Transient transfection was conducted using Fugene HD reagent (Invitrogen, NY, USA) per manufacturer's instructions. Briefly, MDA-MB-453 and BT474 cells were seeded in 100 mm.sup.2 culture dishes and incubated overnight. Culture medium was changed to FBS free media 1 h prior to transfection, and 15 g STAT3C over-expression vector (#24983, Addgene, MA, USA), 45 L Fugene HD together with 879 L opti-MEM (Invitrogen, NY) was added into each dish. Eight hours after transfection, the media was removed and changed to regular media containing 10% FBS. Twelve hours later, cells were treated with either 10 M HJC0152 or vehicle as designated. After 12 h treatment, total cell lysates were collected and proceeded to Western blot analysis.
(411) Western Blot Analysis:
(412) Total cells and tissue lysates were prepared using the methods described previously (Chen, H. et al., 2013a; Chen, H. et al., 2013b). Antibodies from Epitomics (Burlingame, Calif.) were used for: STAT1(#ab109320, phospho-STAT1(Y701)(#ab109457), phospho-STAT1 (5727)(#ab109461), STAT2(#ab134192), phospho-STAT3(Y705)(#2236-1), phospho-STAT3(5727)(#ab32143), STAT4(#ab68156s), STAT5(#32043), phospho-STAT5a(Y694)(#32364), phospho-STAT5a(5726)(#ab128896), STATE (#ab32108), cyclin D1(#2261-1), PARP1(#1072-1), cleaved PARP1(#1072-1), JAK1(#ab133666), phosphor-JAK1(pY1022)(#ab38519, JAK2(#ab108596), and phosphor-JAK2(pY1007+pY1008)(#ab68268). Antibodies from Cell Signal Inc: STAT3(#4904s), cleaved caspase3(#9661s), and Bcl-xl (#ab2764). Mcl-1(#S-19) was purchased from Santa Cruz (Santa Cruz, Calif.), and -actin (#AC-15, Sigma, MO).
(413) IL-6 Induction of STAT3 Phosphorylation and Nuclear Translocation:
(414) A total of 510.sup.4 MDA-MB-231 cells were seeded into each well of the chamber slides (#154526, Thermo, N.Y.) and cultured overnight. Cells were starved up to 24 h prior to the designated drug treatment. The cells were then treated with vehicle (0.1% DMSO) or HJC0152 at 5 or 10 M concentrations for 6 h. After stimulation with IL-6 (50 ng/mL) for 1 h, the culture media were aspirated and followed by DPBS (Gibco, Auckland, NZ) wash twice. Then cells were fixed with 4% paraformaldehyde for 10 min, followed by permeabilization using 100% methanol, blocking buffer for 1 h at room temperature, and incubation with primary antibodies at 4 C. overnight. After incubation with secondary antibody for 1 h, slides were stained with DAPI (Invitrogen, CA) for 5 min, and then anti-fade mounting media added to each chamber. Cells were then analyzed under immunofluorescence microscope with laser-scanning confocal imaging system (Nikon TS100F).
(415) Cell Cycle Assay and Apoptosis Assay:
(416) Cell cycle and apoptosis kits (#MCH100106 and #MCH100105, Millipore, MA) were used. MDA-MB-231 cells were incubated in 6-well plates (2.510.sup.5/well) in 2 mL culture media, treated with DMSO, niclosamide or HJC0152 at different concentrations. 24 and 48 h after drug treatment, both adherent and floating cells were collected, washed once with PBS and fixed in cold ethanol for at least 4 h before cell cycle analysis. The fixed cells were then washed twice with PBS and resuspended in 200 L cell cycle detection reagent, incubated for 30 minutes in dark at room temperature. Cell cycle distribution was measured by the Muse Cell Analyzer with Muse Cell Cycle. Similarly, MDA-MB-231 cells with the same treatments were prepared for apoptosis assay. After washing with PBS, resuspended cells were incubated with 100 L PBS containing 1% BSA and 100 L Annexin V and dead cell detection reagent in dark for 20 minutes at room temperature. Apoptosis was measured immediately using the Muse Cell Analyzer with the Muse Apoptosis Program.
(417) Tumor Xenografts and In Vivo Treatment Experiment:
(418) All procedures including mice and in vivo experiments were approved by the Institutional Animal Care and Use Committee of MD Anderson Cancer Center. Twenty-two female nude mice (8 wks of age) were obtained from MDACC ERC Center. Mice were maintained in a barrier unit with 12 h light-dark switch. Freshly harvested MDA-MB-231 cells were injected into the 3.sup.rd mammary fat pad of each mouse (2.510.sup.6 cells per mouse, resuspended in 100 L PBS), and the mice were then randomized (5-10 mice/group). Mice were given 25 mg/kg of HJC0152, 75 mg/kg of niclosamide, or vehicle daily for a total of 14 days by oral gavage, starting when the tumor volume reached approximately 100 mm.sup.3. All drugs were solubilized in 50:50/DMSO:Poly ethylene glycol. Body weights and tumors volume were measured daily and tumor volume calculated using the formula V=0.5LW.sup.2, where L=length (mm) and W=width (mm) of xenograft tumors. Signs of toxicity were recorded individually. Experimental mouse was sacrificed when a tumor reached 1.5 cm in diameter or at the end of experiments. Lung, colon, stomach, heart, brain, kidney, liver, and tumor tissues were collected and fixed in 4% formalin overnight, paraffin embedded and sectioned for H&E staining or immunohistochemical staining (IHC).
(419) Immunohistochemistry (IHC):
(420) Paraffin blocks of the collected tissue were sectioned into 4 m thickness and stained with H&E as a reference. All slides were subjected to phospho-STAT3 (Y705) IHC with ABC staining method. Rabbit or mouse IgG ABC kit was purchased from Vector Laboratories (Burlingame, Calif., USA) and ABC staining reagents were purchased from Sigma Aldrich (Louis, MO, USA). PBS was used instead of primary antibody as a negative control.
(421) RPPA and Bioinformatics Analysis:
(422) MDA-MB-231 cells were seeded into 6-well plates at a density of 50% confluence overnight. Cells were treated the following day with either 10 M of HJC0152 or vehicle for 6 h when the cells reached 80% confluence. At the designated time points, culture media was aspired, dishes washed with chilled PBS buffer twice, and then 150 L of cell lysate buffer (1% Triton X-100, 50 mM HEPES, pH 7.4, 150 mM NaCl, 1.5 mM MgCl.sub.2, 1 mM EGTA, 100 mM NaF, 10 mM Sodium pyrophosphate, 1 mM Na.sub.3VO.sub.4, 10% glycerol) added (containing protease and phosphatase inhibitor). Supernatant was collected after 20 min of incubation with occasional shaking, after centrifuging at 13,300 rpm for 10 min at 4 C. Protein concentrations were determined using a BCA kit (Piece, CA). The protein concentrations were adjusted to 1 g/L in the lysates and 40 g of protein used for RPPA analysis at the CCSG Core of MD Anderson Cancer Center. Briefly, samples were printed onto slides in five two-fold-serial dilutions (from undiluted to 1:16 dilution). Validated primary antibodies were used to probe the tissue sections and the signal was amplified by a secondary antibody, until a stable dye was precipitated (Spurrier, B. et al., 2008). Quantified data were produced from the stained slides using Microvigene software (Vigene Tech, Carlisle, Mass.). All samples were probed with 167 validated antibodies.
(423) Statistical analysis of RPPA data: Relative protein levels for each sample were generated from the 5 serial dilutions by Supercurve algorithms (Hu, J. et al., 2007). Normalization was the most important step in data analysis (Cai, G. et al., 2012), and quantile normalization was applied to raw values (Bolstad, B. M. et al., 2003). Analysis using unbiased clustering was performed on antibodies but with samples kept in order. Log.sub.2 signals were centered by median and scaled to standard Z scores on antibodies and clustering was based on Pearson correlation distance. Differential expression of proteins was assessed using standard two sample t tests. And the false discovery rate (FDR) control was performed to account for multiple comparison adjustment (Benjamini, Y. et al., 1995). A p-value of less than 0.05 was considered significant. Comparing two conditions 51 and S2, for gene i, M (log ratios) was calculated as M.sub.i=log.sub.2 S1.sub.ilog.sub.2 S2.sub.i and A (mean average) was calculated as
(424)
To determine pathways and networks that were significantly regulated between conditions, the top 20 differentially expressed genes were selected as described in Table 7 and Table 8 and performed pathway enrichment analysis using Ingenuity Pathway Analysis (IPA) software. Top enriched networks, diseases and disorders, molecular and cellular functions, and physiological system development and function were identified from IPA analysis.
(425) To search the STAT3 binding site(s) for the genes in Table 9, the UCSC Genome Browser was used. The UCSC Genome Browser is developed and maintained by the Genome Bioinformatics Group, a cross-departmental team within the Center for Biomolecular Science and Engineering (CBSE) at the University of California Santa Cruz (UCSC).
(426) Statistical Analysis:
(427) Statistical analysis was performed on meanstandard error values of three independent experiments using GraphPad Prism 5 Software. The significance of differences between groups was determined by comparing student's t test at *P<0.05, **P<0.01, and ***P<0.005, 2-sided. For xenograft tumor growth experiment, ANOVA was used to compare the statistical difference of treatment with vehicle, HJC0152 or niclosamide.
(428) Differential Expression of STAT3 and its Phosphorylation Status Among ER-Negative and ER-Positive Breast Cancer Cells.
(429) As described in the above examples, the inventors found that HJC0152 (chemical structure shown in
(430) HJC0152 Inhibits IL-6 Induced STAT3 Phosphorylation and Nuclear Translocation.
(431) To determine whether HJC0152 affects STAT3 and its phosphorylation in cells with forced STAT3 expression, STAT3-expressing vector was transiently transfected into breast cancer cells that have lower STAT3 protein levels. As shown in
(432) Dynamic Alterations of STAT3 Phosphorylation in Triple-Negative Breast Cancer Cells after Treating with HJC0152.
(433) To determine the dynamic patterns in protein level after treating with HJC0152, MDA-MB-231 and MDA-MB-468 cells were treated for 3, 6, 12, and 24 h with a single administration of HJC0152 or niclosamide, which served as the lead compound for HJC0152 synthesis. In MDA-MB-231 cells, HJC0152 significantly decreased pSTAT3 at Y705 residue at 6 h of treatment but gradually recovered at 24 h of treatment, while 5727 residue showed a continuous inhibition to 24 h. Apoptotic marker cleaved caspase 3 was induced at 12 h of treatment, while the apoptotic protein Mcl-1 showed a decrease starting from 6 h of treatment. The expression of Bcl-xl protein and cyclin D1 was not altered for 24 h of treatment, while 72 h of treatment decreased cyclin D1 significantly as reported by the inventors (Chen, H. et al., 2013a; Chen, H. et al., 2013b), suggesting that cyclinD1 might be indirectly regulated. Other STAT proteins were next examined and it was found that there were no significant changes for STAT1 and active STAT1 at Y701 or S727 residues, and STAT2, STAT4 and STATE showed minimal changes after HJC0152 treatment. STAT5 showed a transient decrease at 6 h with 5 and 10 M of HJC0152 treatment, and recovered at 12 h and beyond. The pSTAT5 showed moderate decrease at 12 and 24 h with 5 and 10 M of HJC0152 treatment. The expression of JAKs positioned upstream of STAT3 were also examined. There were no changes in JAK1 or pJAK1 (Y1022). However, starting from 6 h of HJC0152 treatment, analysis of JAK2 and pJAK2 (Y1007 & Y1008) showed apparent down-regulation of protein with 5 M and 10 M of HJC0152 treatment (
(434) Similarly, MDA-MB-468 cells showed down-regulation of STAT3 and pSTAT3 starting at 3 h and maximized to 24 h of HJC01152 treatment (
(435) HJC0152 Inhibits Proliferation and Colony Formation, and is Well Tolerated in Normal and Immortal Mammary Epithelial Cells.
(436) To study the effects of HJC0152 on cell growth, MTT assays were performed on HMEC, MCF-10A and MDA-MB-231 cells. The growth of MDA-MB-231 cells was suppressed in a dose-dependent manner after treating with HJC0152 and niclosamide, with similar morphological change (
(437) HJC0152 Induces Apoptosis of TNBC Cells.
(438) Blocking STAT3 signaling in many different tumor cells leads to induce growth arrest and apoptosis (Bromberg, J., 2002; Turkson, J., 2004; Siddiquee, K. et al., 2007; Catlett-Falcone, R. et al., 1999; Zhang, X. et al., 2012). As shown in
(439) HJC0152 Significantly Suppresses the Growth of Xenograft Tumors Arose from TNBC Cell Line MDA-MB-231, Via Suppressing STAT3 Signaling.
(440) To determine whether HJC0152 actually inhibits the growth of TNBC tumors, MDA-MB-231 xenograft tumors were developed in nude mice and the mice were treated with HJC0152, niclosamide or vehicle by oral gavage daily for 14 days. Tumor-bearing mice were treated with niclosamide at 75 mg/kg showed significant inhibition of tumor growth (55% reduction). At one-third of the dose of niclosamide, mice treated with HJC0152 at 25 mg/kg showed approximately 80% reduction in tumor growth. Comparing to niclosamide, HJC0152 is significantly potent in inhibiting xenograft tumor growth (p: HJC0152 vs vehicle=0.0001, niclosamide vs vehicle=0.0001, HJC0152 vs niclosamide=0.023,
(441) Identification of Signal Molecules and Signal Transduction Pathways Mediating the Inhibitory Effect from HJC0152
(442) To identify the signal molecules and signal transduction pathways involved after HJC0152 treatment, the protein level of 167 signal molecules was measured using RPPA analysis and a heatmap of all proteins was created. MDA-MB-231 cells were treated for 6 h for analysis. RPPA data were obtained from RPPA facility and imported into IPA software and analyzed. In Table 9, the top 20 signal proteins were identified in up-regulated or down-regulated directions are listed. Total EEF2K, cyclin D1, FoxM1, PDCD4, TEF1, p27; and active AMPK(pT172), EGFR(pY1068), NF-B(pS536) and MEK1(pS221) were among the down-regulated proteins with statistical significance. Total Annexin VII, MEK1, MIG-6, PEA15; and active Akt(pT308 and pS473), BAD(pS112), elF4E(pS209), p38(pT180 & Y182), and 4E-BP1(pT70) are among the top 10 up-regulated molecules. The identified genes are associated with three major signal networks: (1) cell cycle, cancer, cell morphology, (2) cancer, dermatological diseases and conditions, protein synthesis, and (3) cell death and survival, tumor morphology, and embryonic development. Cancer is the #1 disease/disorder connected to these genes, and the genes are closely related to protein synthesis, cell cycle, cell death and survival, and cell proliferation. In addition, the identified genes are also related to physiological development of hepatic, connective tissue and digestive system, and tissue and tumor morphology. Network connections for the regulated proteins are shown in Table 10. The genes and networks identified after HJC0152 treatment belong to MAPK, PI3K/Akt, PTEN, ErbB, and IL signaling pathways from IPA analysis. Taken together, HJC0152 regulates genes important to cell proliferation, apoptosis, and signal transduction pathways. The majority of the genes are direct target genes of STAT3, as these genes have STAT3 regulatory elements in the promoter region, as shown in Table. 9, supporting the idea that STAT3 is the major target of HJC0152.
(443) TABLE-US-00007 TABLE 9 STAT3 binding site(s) Gene Protein Function in gene promotor M A p value Down-regulated Proteins PRKAA1 AMPK_pT172 Energy sensor protein kinase No 0.534205 0.2567 0.000736 EEF2K eEF2K Protein synthesis Yes (1) 0.404648 1.36682 0.002087 CCND1 Cyclin_D1 Cell cycle progression No 0.170533 0.67692 0.018496 FOXM1 FoxM1 Cell proliferation No 0.153734 0.63592 0.021902 PDCD4 PDCD4 Apoptosis, JNK activation Yes (1) 0.373667 0.117163 0.025799 TFF1 TTF1 Not clear, expression in cancer & Yes (6) 0.096924 1.02753 0.022408 gastric mucosa EGFR EGFR_pY1068 Master protein kinase Yes (24) 0.170301 2.55326 0.040426 NFKB1 NF-kB-p65_pS536 Transcription regulator Yes (1) 0.319279 0.19996 0.041405 CDKN1B p27 CDK inhibitor, cell cycle No 0.043964 2.1379 0.037485 MAP2K1 MEK1_pS217_S221 Kinase involved in proliferation, Yes (4) 0.230587 0.68168 0.047882 differentiation, transcription regulation & development Up-regulated Proteins AKT1 Akt_pT308 Protein kinase regulating metabolism, Yes (4) 0.43552 1.65867 0.024296 AKT2 proliferation, cell survival, growth & AKT3 angiogenesis ANXA7 Annexin_VII Calcium-dependent phospholipid No 0.1289 0.039204 0.016086 binding proteins, exocytosis BAD Bad_pS112 Apoptosis regulator Yes (2) 0.09218 1.5298 0.017081 EIF4E eIF4E_pS209 Protein synthesis Yes (4) 0.25874 0.65622 0.016361 MAP2K1 MEK1 Proliferation, differentiation, Yes (4) 0.11175 0.38455 0.01558 transcription regulation & development ERRFI1 MIG-6 Cell growth, negative regulator of Yes (1) 0.20218 0.35739 0.007262 EGFR family proteins MAPK14 p38_pT180_Y182 Cell proliferation, differentiation, No 0.24499 0.63223 0.020982 transcription regulation & development PEA15 PEA15 Regulate MAP kinase cascade & No 0.08518 0.26359 0.025838 glucose metabolism AKT1 Akt_pS473 Protein kinase regulating metabolism, Yes (4) 0.554 2.46531 0.033567 AKT2 proliferation, cell survival, growth & AKT3 angiogenesis EIF4EBP1 4E-BP1_pT70 Interact with eIF4E & mediate protein Yes (1) 0.03679 0.12821 0.051809 synthesis by hormones, growth factors and other stimuli that signal through the MAP kinase
(444) TABLE-US-00008 TABLE 10 Top Networks ID Associated Network Functions Score 1 Cell Cycle, Cancer, Cell Morphology 24 2 Cancer, Dermatological Diseases and Conditions, 11 Protein Synthesis 3 Cell Death and Survival, Tumor Morphology, 4 Embryonic Development Name p-value #Molecules Diseases and Disorders Cancer 8.60E14-6.50E04 12 Hematological Disease 3.97E13-8.93E04 13 Dermatological Diseases 1.43E12-8.89E04 16 and Conditions Developmental Disorder 3.21E11-9.15E04 17 Cellular Development 2.61E10-9.15E04 17 Molecular and Cellular Functions Protein Synthesis 1.75E10-2.14E02 7 Cell Cycle 1.75E10-1.99E02 7 Cell Death and Survival 1.15E08-1.89E02 7 Cellular Growth and 1.91E08-2.04E02 6 Proliferation Cell Death and Survival 1.19E07-2.09E02 7 Physiological System Development and Function Hepatic System Development 3.25E10-8.12E04 7 and Function Connective Tissue Development 1.62E08-8.93E04 10 and Function Tissue Morphology 4.05E08-7.78E04 12 Tumor Morphology 9.67E08-9.74E04 11 Digestive System Development 1.06E07-8.12E04 8 and Function
(445) As shown above, HJC0152 effectively inhibits STAT3 activation in STAT3-expressing cells and blocks nuclear translocation of active STAT3 in TNBC cells stimulated with IL-6, and reduces protein levels of total and phosphorylated STAT3. These changes are mediated by signal pathways associated with cell cycle, cancer, and cell morphology; protein synthesis; and cell death and survival. Thus, the results from this research support that HJC0152 may have multiple targets in signal transduction pathways, while STAT3 signaling is its major effector of its anti-cancer efficacy. The favorable aqueous solubility of HJC0152 further supports use of this compound for cancer prevention and treatment.
(446) In xenograft tumor treatment studies, the efficacy of HJC0152 and niclosamide via oral administration was compared. Consistent with the data provided in the above examples, HJC0152 at a dose of 25 mg/kg given 5 days/week for 1-2 week(s) via i.p. or oral gavage inhibits the growth of xenograft tumors arose from MDA-MD-231 cells. The tumor-bearing nude mice were further treated with a continuous 14-day oral gavage of HJC0152 at 25 mg/kg or niclosamide at 75 mg/kg, starting the treatment when tumor volume reached approximately 100 mm.sup.3. The inhibition on tumor growth with low dose of HJC0152 is significantly better than high dose of niclosamide. At 25 mg/kg dose, the mice taking oral HJC0152 maintained excellent health status without any noticeable side effects or toxicity, and the body weight maintained stable for the entire experimental period (
(447) HJC0152 is effective and potent to suppress STAT3 activation via down-regulating total STAT3 and active forms of STAT3, as demonstrated by IHC and Western blot (
(448) To evaluate the molecular networks and signal transduction pathways mediating anti-cancer effect of HJC0152, RPPA studies were performed and top regulated genes were identified in both up-and down-regulated directions. The majority of the genes identified are direct target genes of STAT3, as evidenced by the presence of STAT3 binding site(s) in their promoter regions. Particularly, AMPK, EGFR, NF-B and MEK signaling were observed to be down-regulated, supporting the idea that the inhibitory effects of HJC0152 are mediated by these master regulators of signal transduction pathways. Without wishing to be bound by any theory, genes critical for protein synthesis and energy metabolism such as eEF2K, AMPK, elF4E, and its binding protein 4E-BP1, and PEA15 were significantly affected, suggesting that HJC0152 may exert its inhibition via down-regulation of protein synthesis and energy balance. Three major molecular networks connect HJC0152 to the cell cycle, cell morphology, cell death and survival, and protein synthesis (
(449) The inventors have considered that STAT3 may or may not be the direct target for HJC0152. The results presented herein support the idea that STAT3 is a major effector of HJC0152, as evidenced by the down-regulation of total STAT3 and its active forms both at Y705 and 5727 phosphorylation site in in vitro and in vivo experiments, while other STAT family members and JAK2/JAK3 may be down-regulated via STAT3 inhibition from HJC0152. Without wishing to be bound by any theory, HJC0152 may indirectly inhibit STAT3 via multiple mechanisms such as interrupting ATP synthesis and reactive oxidative species resulting in mitochondrial fragmentation. Whether STAT3 has direct interaction with HJC0152 may be tested via affinity pull-down and other approaches. HJC0152 may be used to inhibit cancer progression and/or metastasis, as STAT3 is involved in the progression of cancer to metastasis. Since STAT3 is critically involved in early carcinogenesis of breast cancer, it is anticipated that compounds disclosed herein, such as HJC0152, may be used to either treat an existing cancer, or slow or prevent the development of a cancer in a subject such as a human patient.
* * *
(450) All of the methods disclosed and claimed herein can be made and executed without undue experimentation in light of the present disclosure. While the compositions and methods of this invention have been described in terms of preferred embodiments, it will be apparent to those of skill in the art that variations may be applied to the methods and in the steps or in the sequence of steps of the method described herein without departing from the concept, spirit and scope of the invention. More specifically, it will be apparent that certain agents which are both chemically and physiologically related may be substituted for the agents described herein while the same or similar results would be achieved. All such similar substitutes and modifications apparent to those skilled in the art are deemed to be within the spirit, scope and concept of the invention as defined by the appended claims.
REFERENCES
(451) The following references, to the extent that they provide exemplary procedural or other details supplementary to those set forth herein, are specifically incorporated herein by reference. U.S. Pat. No. 5,629,001 U.S. Pat. No. 6,613,308 U.S. Pat. No. 5,466,468 U.S. Pat. No. 5,543,158 U.S. Pat. No. 5,641,515 U.S. Pat. No. 5,580,579 U.S. Pat. No. 5,792,451 U.S. Pat. No. 5,399,363 U.S. Pat. No. 5,466,468 U.S. Pat. No. 5,756,353 U.S. Pat. No. 5,804,212 U.S. Pat. No. 5,725,871 U.S. Pat. No. 5,780,045 Anderson, N. G., Practical Process Research & DevelopmentA Guide For Organic Chemists, 2.sup.nd ed., Academic Press, New York, 2012. Handbook of Pharmaceutical Salts: Properties, and Use, Stahl and Wermuth Eds.), Verlag Helvetica Chimica Acta, 2002. March's Advanced Organic Chemistry: Reactions, Mechanisms, and Structure, 2007. Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 21.sup.st Ed. Lippincott Williams and Wilkins, 2005. Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18.sup.th Ed. Mack Printing Company, 1990. Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 15.sup.th Ed., 1035-1038 and 1570-1580, 1990. T. Ara, R. Nakata, M. A. Sheard, H. Shimada, R. Buettner, S. G. Groshen, L. Ji, H. Yu, R. Jove, R. C. Seeger, Y. A. DeClerck, Critical role of STAT3 in IL-6-mediated drug resistance in human neuroblastoma. Cancer research 73 (2013) 3852-3864. K. Babaoglu, B. K. Shoichet, Deconstructing fragment-based inhibitor discovery. Nat. Chem. Biol. 2 (2006) 720-723. S. Barelier, I. Krimm, Ligand specificity, privileged substructures and protein druggability from fragment-based screening. Curr. Opin. Chem. Biol. 15 (2011) 469-474. Becker, S.; Groner, B.; Mller, C. W. Three-dimensional structure of the Stat3beta homodimer bound to DNA. Nature 1998, 394, 145-151. Y. Benjamini, Y. Hochberg, Controlling the false discovery rate: a practical and powerful approach to multiple testing. Journal of the Royal Statistical Society Series B 57 (1995) 289-300. Bergstrm, C. A.; Wassvik, C. M.; Johansson, K.; Hubatsch, I. Poorly soluble marketed drugs display solvation limited solubility. J. Med. Chem. 2007, 50, 5858-5862. B. M. Bolstad, R. A. Irizarry, M. Astrand, T. P. Speed, A comparison of normalization methods for high density oligonucleotide array data based on variance and bias. Bioinformatics 19 (2003) 185-193. Bowman, T.; Garcia, R.; Turkson, J.; Jove, R. STATs in oncogenesis. Oncogene 2000, 19, 2474-2488. Bromberg, J. F.; Wrzeszczynska, M. H.; Devgan, G.; Zhao, Y.; Pestell, R. G.; Albanese, C.; Darnell, J. E., Jr. Stat3 as an oncogene. Cell 1999, 98, 295-303. Bromberg, J.; Darnell, J. E., Jr. The role of STATs in transcriptional control and their impact on cellular function. Oncogene 2000, 19, 2468-2473. Bromberg, J. Stat proteins and oncogenesis. J. Clin. Invest. 2002, 109, 1139-1142. Buettner, R.; Mora, L. B.; Jove, R. Activated STAT signaling in human tumors provides novel molecular targets for therapeutic intervention. Clin. Cancer Res. 2002, 8, 945-954. G. Cai, H. Li, Y. Lu, X. Huang, J. Lee, P. Muller, Y. Ji, S. Liang, Accuracy of RNA-Seq and its dependence on sequencing depth. BMC Bioinformatics 13 Suppl 13 (2012) S5. R. Catlett-Falcone, T. H. Landowski, M. M. Oshiro, J. Turkson, A. Levitzki, R. Savino, G. Ciliberto, L. Moscinski, J. L. Fernandez-Luna, G. Nufiez, W. S. Dalton, R. Jove, Constitutive activation of Stat3 signaling confers resistance to apoptosis in human U266 myeloma cells. Immunity 10 (1999) 105-115. Chapman R S, Lourenco P C, Tonner E, Flint D J, Selbert S, Takeda K, et al. Suppression of epithelial apoptosis and delayed mammary gland involution in mice with a conditional knockout of Stat3. Genes Dev 1999 Oct. 1; 13 (19): 2604-2616. H. Chen, Z. Yang, C. Ding, L. Chu, Y. Zhang, K. Terry, H. Liu, Q. Shen, J. Zhou, Discovery of -Alkylamino Tethered Niclosamide Derivatives as Potent and Orally Bioavailable Anticancer Agents. ACS Med Chem Lett 4 (2013) 180-185. H. Chen, Z. Yang, C. Ding, L. Chu, Y. Zhang, K. Terry, H. Liu, Q. Shen, J. Zhou, Fragment-based drug design and identification of HJC0123, a novel orally bioavailable STAT3 inhibitor for cancer therapy. Eur J Med Chem 62 (2013) 498-507. Chen, J.; Bai, L.; Bernard, D.; Nikolovska-Coleska, Z.; Gomez, C.; Zhang, J.; Yi, H.; Wang, S. Structure-based design of conformationally constrained, cell-permeable STAT3 inhibitors. ACS Med. Chem. Lett. 2010, 1, 85-89. Coletta R D, Jedlicka P, Gutierrez-Hartmann A, Ford H L. Transcriptional control of the cell cycle in mammary gland development and tumorigenesis. J Mammary Gland Biol Neoplasia 2004 January; 9 (1): 39-53. L. Costantino, D. Barlocco, STAT3 as a target for cancer drug discovery. Curr. Med. Chem. 15 (2008) 834-843. Darnell, J. E., Jr. STATs and gene regulation. Science 1997, 277, 1630-1635. Darnell, J. E., Jr. Transcription factors as targets for cancer therapy. Nat. Rev. Cancer 2002, 2, 740-749. Darnell, J. E., Jr. Validating Stat3 in cancer therapy. Nat. Med. 2005, 11, 595-596. Debnath, B.; Xu, S.; Neamati, N. Small molecule inhibitors of signal transducer and activator of transcription 3 (Stat3) protein. J. Med. Chem. 2012, 55, 6645-6668. Deng, J.; Grande, F.; Neamati, N. Small molecule inhibitors of Stat3 signaling pathway. Curr. Cancer Drug Targets 2007, 7, 91-107. Elkihel, L.; Loiseau, P. M.; Bourass, J.; Gayral, P.; Letourneux, Y. Synthesis and orally macrofilaricidal evaluation of niclosamide lymphotropic prodrugs. Arzneimittelforschung 1994, 44, 1259-1264. D. A. Erlanson, R. S. McDowell, T. O'Brien, Fragment-based drug discovery. J. Med. Chem. 47 (2004) 3463-3482. D. Germain, D. A. Frank, Targeting the cytoplasmic and nuclear functions of signal transducers and activators of transcription 3 for cancer therapy. Clin. Cancer Res. 13 (2007) 5665-5669. Haftchenary, S.; Avadisian, M.; Gunning, P. T Inhibiting aberrant Stat3 function with molecular therapeutics: a progress report. Anticancer Drugs 2011, 22, 115-127. P. J. Hajduk, Fragment-based drug design: how big is too big? J. Med. Chem. 49 (2006) 6972-6976. P. J. Hajduk, J. Greer, A decade of fragment-based drug design: strategic advances and lessons learned. Nat. Rev. Drug Discovery 6 (2007) 211-219. Hann, M. M.; Keser, G. M. Finding the sweet spot: the role of nature and nurture in medicinal chemistry. Nat. Rev. Drug Discov. 2012, 11, 355-365. S. Haricharan, Y. Li, STAT signaling in mammary gland differentiation, cell survival and tumorigenesis. Molecular and cellular endocrinology (2013). E. B. Haura, J. Turkson, R. Jove, Mechanisms of disease: Insights into the emerging role of signal transducers and activators of transcription in cancer. Nat. Clin. Pract. Oncol. 2 (2005) 315-324. T. Hirano, K. Ishihara, M. Hibi, Roles of STAT3 in mediating the cell growth, differentiation and survival signals relayed through the IL-6 family of cytokine receptors. Oncogene 19 (2000) 2548-2556. A. Horiguchi, T. Asano, K. Kuroda, A. Sato, J. Asakuma, K. Ito, M. Hayakawa, M. Sumitomo, T. Asano, STAT3 inhibitor WP1066 as a novel therapeutic agent for renal cell carcinoma. Br. J. Cancer 102 (2010) 1592-1599. F. C. Hsieh, G. Cheng, J. Lin, Evaluation of potential Stat3-regulated genes in human breast cancer. Biochem Biophys Res Commun 335 (2005) 292-299. J. Hu, X. He, K. A. Baggerly, K. R. Coombes, B. T. Hennessy, G. B. Mills, Non-parametric quantification of protein lysate arrays. Bioinformatics 23 (2007) 1986-1994. Ishikawa, M.; Hashimoto, Y. Improvement in aqueous solubility in small molecule drug discovery programs by disruption of molecular planarity and symmetry. J. Med. Chem. 2011, 54, 1539-1554. A. Iwamaru, S. Szymanski, E. Iwado, H. Aoki, T. Yokoyama, I. Fokt, K. Hess, C. Conrad, T. Madden, R. Sawaya, S. Kondo, W. Priebe, Y. Kondo, A novel inhibitor of the STAT3 pathway induces apoptosis in malignant glioma cells both in vitro and in vivo. Oncogene 26 (2007) 2435-2444. Jin, Y.; Lu, Z.; Ding, K.; Li, J.; Du, X.; Chen, C.; Sun, X.; Wu, Y.; Zhou, J.; Pan, J. Antineoplastic mechanisms of niclosamide in acute myelogenous leukemia stem cells: inactivation of the NF-kappaB pathway and generation of reactive oxygen species. Cancer Res. 2010, 70, 2516-2527. P. A. Johnston, J. R. Grandis, STAT3 signaling: anticancer strategies and challenges. Mol. Interv. 11 (2011) 18-26. H. Kida, S. Ihara, A. Kumanogoh, Involvement of STAT3 in immune evasion during lung tumorigenesis. Oncoimmunology 2 (2013) e22653. B. H. Kim, C. Won, Y. H. Lee, J. S. Choi, K. H. Noh, S. Han, H. Lee, C. S. Lee, D. S. Lee, S. K. Ye, M. H. Kim, Sophoraflavanone G induces apoptosis of human cancer cells by targeting upstream signals of STATs. Biochemical pharmacology (2013). S. Y. Kim, J. W. Kang, X. Song, B. K. Kim, Y. D. Yoo, Y. T. Kwon, Y. J. Lee, Role of the IL-6-JAK1-STAT3-Oct-4 pathway in the conversion of non-stem cancer cells into cancer stem-like cells. Cellular signalling 25 (2013) 961-969. C. F. Lai, J. Ripperger, Y. Wang, H. Kim, R. B. Hawley, H. Baumann, The STAT3-independent signaling pathway by glycoprotein 130 in hepatic cells. J Biol Chem 274 (1999) 7793-7802. A. Lavecchia, C. Di Giovanni, E. Novellino, STAT-3 inhibitors: state of the art and new horizons for cancer treatment. Curr. Med. Chem. 18 (2011) 2359-2375. Leach, A. G.; Jones, H. D.; Cosgrove, D. A.; Kenny, P. W.; Ruston, L.; MacFaul, P.; Wood, J. M.; Colclough, N.; Law, B. Matched molecular pairs as a guide in the optimization of pharmaceutical properties; a study of aqueous solubility, plasma protein binding and oral exposure. J. Med. Chem. 2006, 49, 6672-6682. H. Li, A. Liu, Z. Zhao, Y. Xu, J. Lin, D. Jou, C. Li, Fragment-based drug design and drug repositioning using multiple ligand simultaneous docking (MLSD): identifying celecoxib and template compounds as novel inhibitors of signal transducer and activator of transcription 3 (STAT3). J. Med. Chem. 54 (2011) 5592-5596. Lipinski, C. A. Drug-like properties and the causes of poor solubility and poor permeability. J. Pharmacol. Toxicol. Methods 2000, 44, 235-249. Liu X, Robinson G W, Wagner K U, Garrett L, Wynshaw-Boris A, Hennighausen L. Stat5a is mandatory for adult mammary gland development and lactogenesis. Genes Dev 1997 Jan. 15; 11 (2): 179-186. Mandal, P. K.; Ren, Z.; Chen, X.; Xiong, C.; McMurray, J. S. Structure-affinity relationships of glutamine mimics incorporated into phosphopeptides targeted to the SH2 domain of signal transducer and activator of transcription 3. J. Med. Chem. 2009, 52, 6126-6141. P. K. Mandal, F. Gao, Z. Lu, Z. Ren, R. Ramesh, J. S. Birtwistle, K. K. Kaluarachchi, X. Chen, R. C. Jr. Bast, W. S. Liao, J. S. McMurray, Potent and selective phosphopeptide mimetic prodrugs targeted to the Src Homology 2 (SH2) domain of signal transducer and activator of transcription 3. J. Med. Chem. 54 (2011) 3549-3563. A. K. Mankan, F. R. Greten, Inhibiting signal transducer and activator of transcription 3: rationality and rationale design of inhibitors. Expert Opin. Invest. Drugs 20 (2011) 1263-1275. K. Matsuno, Y. Masuda, Y. Uehara, H. Sato, A. Muroya, O. Takahashi, T. Yokotagawa, T. Furuya, T. Okawara, M. Otsuka, N. Ogo, T. Ashizawa, C. Oshita, S. Tai, H. Ishii, Y. Akiyama, A. Asai, Identification of a new series of STAT3 inhibitors by virtual screening. ACS Med. Chem. Lett. 1 (2010) 371-375. The Merck Index, 13th ed.; Merck: Rahway, N.Y., 2001. Navab, M.; Ruchala, P.; Waring, A. J.; Lehrer, R. I.; Hama, S.; Hough, G.; Palgunachari, M. N.; Anantharamaiah, G. M.; Fogelman, A. M. A novel method for oral delivery of apolipoprotein mimetic peptides synthesized from all L-amino acids. J. Lipid Res. 2009, 50, 1538-1547. G. Niu, K. L. Wright, M. Huang, L. Song, E. Haura, J. Turkson, S. Zhang, T. Wang, D. Sinibaldi, D. Coppola, R. Heller, L. M. Ellis, J. Karras, J. Bromberg, D. Pardoll, R. Jove, H. Yu, Constitutive Stat3 activity up-regulates VEGF expression and tumor angiogenesis. Oncogene 21 (2002) 2000-2008. O'Neill, V. J.; Twelves, C. J. Oral cancer treatment: developments in chemotherapy and beyond. Br. J. Cancer 2002, 87, 933-937. Osada, T.; Chen, M.; Yang, X. Y.; Spasojevic, I.; Vandeusen, J. B.; Hsu, D.; Clary, B. M.; Clay, T. M.; Chen, W.; Morse, M. A.; Lyerly, H. K. Antihelminth compound niclosamide downregulates Wnt signaling and elicits antitumor responses in tumors with activating APC mutations. Cancer Res. 2011, 71, 4172-4182. Page, B. D.; Ball, D. P.; Gunning, P. T. Signal transducer and activator of transcription 3 inhibitors: a patent review. Expert Opin. Ther. Pat. 2011, 21, 65-83. J. X. Pan, K. Ding, C. Y. Wang, Niclosamide, an old antihelminthic agent, demonstrates antitumor activity by blocking multiple signaling pathways of cancer stem cells. Chin J Cancer 31 (2012) 178-184. S. J. Park, J. H. Shin, H. Kang, J. J. Hwang, D. H. Cho, Niclosamide induces mitochondria fragmentation and promotes both apoptotic and autophagic cell death. BMB Rep 44 (2011) 517-522. P. F. Peddi, M. J. Ellis, C. Ma, Molecular basis of triple negative breast cancer and implications for therapy. Int J Breast Cancer 2012 (2012) 217185. Ranger J J, Levy D E, Shahalizadeh S, Hallett M, Muller W J. Identification of a Stat3-dependent transcription regulatory network involved in metastatic progression. Cancer Res 2009 Sep. 1; 69 (17): 6823-6830. D. C. Rees, M. Congreve, C. W. Murray, R. Carr, Fragment-based lead discovery. Nat. Rev. Drug Discovery 3 (2004) 660-672. Ren X, Duan L, He Q., Zhang Z., Zhou, Y., Wu D., Pan J., Pei D., Ding K. Identification of Niclosamide as a New Small-Molecule Inhibitor of the STAT3 Signaling Pathway. ACS Med. Chem. Lett. 2010; 1:454-459. P. Sansone, J. Bromberg, Targeting the interleukin-6/Jak/stat pathway in human malignancies. Journal of clinical oncology: official journal of the American Society of Clinical Oncology 30 (2012) 1005-1014. C. W. Schindler, Series introduction. JAK-STAT signaling in human disease. J. Clin. Invest. 109 (2002) 1133-1137. Schott, S.; Schneeweiss, A.; Reinhardt, J.; Bruckner, T.; Domschke, C.; Sohn, C.; Eichbaum, M. H. Acceptance of oral chemotherapy in breast cancer patientsa survey study. BMC Cancer 2011, 11, 129. Schust, J., Sperl, B., Hollis, A., Mayer, T. U., Berg, T. Stattic: A Small-Molecule Inhibitor of STAT3 Activation and Dimerization. Chemistry & Biology 2006; 13, 1235-1242. Q. Shen, I. P. Uray, Y. Li, T. I. Krisko, T. E. Strecker, H. T. Kim, P. H. Brown, The AP-1 transcription factor regulates breast cancer cell growth via cyclins and E2F factors. Oncogene 27 (2008) 366-377. K. Siddiquee, S. Zhang, W. C. Guida, M. A. Blaskovich, B. Greedy, H. R. Lawrence, M. L. Yip, R. Jove, M. M. McLaughlin, N. J. Lawrence, S. M. Sebti, J. Turkson, Selective chemical probe inhibitor of Stat3, identified through structure-based virtual screening, induces antitumor activity. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 104 (2007) 7391-7396. Siddiquee, K.; Turkson, J. STAT3 as a target for inducing apoptosis in solid and hematological tumors. Cell Res. 2008, 18, 254-267. H. Song, R. Wang, S. Wang, J. Lin, A low-molecular-weight compound discovered through virtual database screening inhibits Stat3 function in breast cancer cells. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 102 (2005) 4700-4705. B. Spurrier, S. Ramalingam, S. Nishizuka, Reverse-phase protein lysate microarrays for cell signaling analysis. Nat Protoc 3 (2008) 1796-1808. Takeda K, Clausen B E, Kaisho T, Tsujimura T, Terada N, Forster I, et al. Enhanced Th1 activity and development of chronic enterocolitis in mice devoid of Stat3 in macrophages and neutrophils. Immunity 1999 January; 10 (1): 39-49. Takeda K, Kaisho T, Yoshida N, Takeda J, Kishimoto T, Akira S. Stat3 activation is responsible for IL-6-dependent T cell proliferation through preventing apoptosis: generation and characterization of T cell-specific Stat3-deficient mice. J Immunol 1998 Nov. 1; 161 (9): 4652-4660. O. Trott, A. J. Olson, AutoDock Vina: improving the speed and accuracy of docking with a new scoring function, efficient optimization, and multithreading. J. Comput. Chem. 31 (2010) 455-461. Turkson, J.; Jove, R. STAT proteins: novel molecular targets for cancer drug discovery. Oncogene 2000, 19, 6613-6626. J. Turkson, D. Ryan, J. S. Kim, Y. Zhang, Z. Chen, E. Haura, A. Laudano, S. Sebti, A. D. Hamilton, R. Jove, Phosphotyrosyl peptides block Stat3-mediated DNA binding activity, gene regulation, and cell transformation. J. Biol. Chem. 276 (2001) 45443-45455. J. Turkson, S. Zhang, J. Palmer, H. Kay, J. Stanko, L. B. Mora, S. Sebti, H. Yu, R. Jove, Inhibition of constitutive signal transducer and activator of transcription 3 activation by novel platinum complexes with potent antitumor activity. Mol. Cancer Ther. 3 (2004) 1533-1542. Turkson J. STAT proteins as novel targets for cancer drug discovery. Expert Opin Ther Targets 2004 October; 8 (5): 409-422. J. Turkson, S. Zhang, L. B. Mora, A. Burns, S. Sebti, R. Jove, A novel platinum compound inhibits constitutive Stat3 signaling and induces cell cycle arrest and apoptosis of malignant cells. J. Biol. Chem. 280 (2005) 32979-32988. Vogel, G. H. Determination of solubility by hyphenated HPLC methods. In Drug Discovery and Evaluation: Safety and Pharmacokinetics Assay; Springer: New York, 2006; pp 400-402. Watson C J. Stat transcription factors in mammary gland development and tumorigenesis. J Mammary Gland Biol Neoplasia 2001 January; 6 (1): 115-127. Xiong, Y.; Teegarden, B. R.; Choi, J. S.; Strah-Pleynet, S.; Decaire, M.; Jayakumar, H.; Dosa, P. I.; Casper, M. D.; Pham, L.; Feichtinger, K.; Ullman, B.; Adams, J.; Yuskin, D.; Frazer, J.; Morgan, M.; Sadeque, A.; Chen, W.; Webb, R. R.; Connolly, D. T.; Semple, G.; Al-Shamma, H. Discovery and structure-activity relationship of 3-methoxy-N-(3-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-4-(2-morpholinoethoxy)phenyl)benzamide (APD791): a highly selective 5-hydroxytryptamine2A receptor inverse agonist for treatment of arterial thrombosis. J. Med. Chem. 2010, 53, 4412-4421. Yeh Y T, Ou-Yang F, Chen I F, Yang S F, Wang Y Y, Chuang H Y, et al. STAT3 ser727 phosphorylation and its association with negative estrogen receptor status in breast infiltrating ductal carcinoma. Int J Cancer 2006 Jun. 15; 118 (12): 2943-2947. Yu H, Jove R. The STATs of cancernew molecular targets come of age. Nat Rev Cancer 2004 February; 4 (2): 97-105. H. Yu, M. Kortylewski, D. Pardoll, Crosstalk between cancer and immune cells: role of STAT3 in the tumour microenvironment. Nat. Rev. Immunol. 7 (2007) 41-51. Yu, H.; Pardoll, D.; Jove, R. STATs in cancer inflammation and immunity: a leading role for STAT3. Nat. Rev. Cancer 2009, 9, 798-809. Yue, P.; Turkson, J. Targeting STAT3 in cancer: how successful are we? Expert Opin. Investig. Drugs 2009, 18, 45-56. Zhang, X.; Yue, P.; Page, B. D.; Li, T.; Zhao, W.; Namanja, A. T.; Paladino, D.; Zhao, J.; Chen, Y.; Gunning, P. T.; Turkson, J. Orally bioavailable small-molecule inhibitor of transcription factor Stat3 regresses human breast and lung cancer xenografts. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 2012, 109, 9623-9628. M. Zhao, B. Jiang, F. H. Gao, Small molecule inhibitors of STAT3 for cancer therapy. Curr. Med. Chem. 18 (2011) 4012-4018. Z. Zhong, Z. Wen, J. E. Jr. Darnell, Stat3: a STAT family member activated by tyrosine phosphorylation in response to epidermal growth factor and interleukin-6. Science 264 (1994) 95-98.